blob: aa55eb4d634186ff3ae1c9d671d1253a4790a2ff [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
671 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
672 information.
673
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100674ssl-server-verify [none|required]
675 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
676 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
677 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
680 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
681 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
682 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
683 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200684
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200685 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
686 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
687 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200688
689stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
690 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
691 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100692 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200693
694stats maxconn <connections>
695 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
696 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698uid <number>
699 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
700 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
702 one. See also "gid" and "user".
703
704ulimit-n <number>
705 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
706 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
707 option.
708
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100709unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
710 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
711
712 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
713 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
714 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
715 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
716 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
717 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
718 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
719 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
720 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
721 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723user <user name>
724 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
725 See also "uid" and "group".
726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200727node <name>
728 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
729
730 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
731 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
732 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
733 traffic.
734
735description <text>
736 Add a text that describes the instance.
737
738 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
739 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
740 "<" and ">" characters.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744-----------------------
745
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200746max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
747 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
748 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
749 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
750 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
751 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
752 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
753 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
754 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756maxconn <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
758 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
759 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200760 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
761 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
762 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
763 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
764 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200766maxconnrate <number>
767 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
768 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
769 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
770 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
771 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
772 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
773 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
774 fairness.
775
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100776maxcomprate <number>
777 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300778 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100779 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
780 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
781 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
782 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
783 default value.
784
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100785maxcompcpuusage <number>
786 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
787 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
788 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
789 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
790 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
791 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
792 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
793 process down and from introducing high latencies.
794
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100795maxpipes <number>
796 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
797 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
798 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
799 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
800 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
801 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
802
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200803maxsessrate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
805 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
806 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
807 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
808 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
809 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
810 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
811 fairness.
812
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200813maxsslconn <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
815 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
816 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
817 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
818 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
819 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
820 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
821
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200822maxsslrate <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
824 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
825 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
826 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
827 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
828 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
829 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
830 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
831 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
832 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
833
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100834maxzlibmem <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
836 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
837 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100838 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
839 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
840 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842noepoll
843 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846
847nokqueue
848 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
849 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
850 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
851
852nopoll
853 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
854 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100855 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100856 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100858nosplice
859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
866 "option splice-response".
867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300868nogetaddrinfo
869 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
870 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
871
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200872spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900873 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
874 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
875 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
876 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
877 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
878 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200879
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200880tune.bufsize <number>
881 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
882 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
883 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
884 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
885 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
886 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
887 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
888 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400889 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
890 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
891 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200892
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200893tune.chksize <number>
894 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
895 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
896 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
897 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
898 checks whenever possible.
899
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100900tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
901 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
902 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
903 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
904 this value. The default value is 1.
905
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100906tune.http.cookielen <number>
907 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
908 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
909 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
910 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
911 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
912 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
913 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
914 to change this value.
915
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200916tune.http.maxhdr <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
918 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
919 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
920 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
921 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
922 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
923 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
924 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
925 limit too high.
926
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100927tune.idletimer <timeout>
928 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
929 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
930 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
931 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
932 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
933 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
934 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
935 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
936 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
937
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100938tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100939 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
940 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
941 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
942 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
943 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
944 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
945 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
946 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
947 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
948 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100949
950tune.maxpollevents <number>
951 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
952 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
953 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
954 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
955 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
956
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200957tune.maxrewrite <number>
958 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
959 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
960 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
961 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
962 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
963 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
964 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
965 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
966 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
967 bufsize.
968
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200969tune.pipesize <number>
970 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
971 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
972 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
973 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
974 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
975 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
976
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100977tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
978tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
979 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
980 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
981 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
982 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
983 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
984 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
985 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
986
987tune.sndbuf.client <number>
988tune.sndbuf.server <number>
989 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
990 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
991 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
992 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
993 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
994 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
995 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
996 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
997 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
998 notifying haproxy again.
999
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001000tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001001 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1002 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1003 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001004 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001005 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1006 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1007 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1008 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1009 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001010 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1011 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001012
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001013tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1014 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1015 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1016 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1017 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1018 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1019 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1020
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001021tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1022 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001023 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001024 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1025 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1026 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1027 being used for too long.
1028
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001029tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1030 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1031 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1032 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1033 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1034 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1035 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1036 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1037 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1038 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1039 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001040 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1041 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001042
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001043tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1044 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1045 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1046 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1047 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1048 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1049 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1050 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1051 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1052
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001053tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1054 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001055 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001056 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1057 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1058 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1059
1060tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1061 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1062 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1063 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1064 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663.3. Debugging
1067--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069debug
1070 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1071 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1072 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1073 system startup.
1074
1075quiet
1076 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1077 line argument "-q".
1078
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010803.4. Userlists
1081--------------
1082It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1083http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1084it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1085
1086userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001087 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1089
1090group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001091 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001092 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1093 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1094
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001095user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1096 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1098 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1100 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001101 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001102 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
1104
1105 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001106 userlist L1
1107 group G1 users tiger,scott
1108 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001110 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1111 user scott insecure-password elgato
1112 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001113
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L2
1115 group G1
1116 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
1122 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
11253.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001126----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1128haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1129pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1130identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1131or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1132Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1133known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1134the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1135process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1136during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1137tables.
1138
1139peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1142
1143peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1144 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1145 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1146 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1147 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1148 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1149 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1150
1151 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1152 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1153
1154 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1155 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1156 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1157 across all peers.
1158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1160 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1161 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1162
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001163 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001164 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001165 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1166 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1167 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001168
1169 backend mybackend
1170 mode tcp
1171 balance roundrobin
1172 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1173 stick on src
1174
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001177
1178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1183 - defaults <name>
1184 - frontend <name>
1185 - backend <name>
1186 - listen <name>
1187
1188A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1189its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1190section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001192
1193A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1194connections.
1195
1196A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1197to forward incoming connections.
1198
1199A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1200parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1203'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1204case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1205
1206Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1207logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1208proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1209However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1210name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1211
1212Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1213and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001214bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1216modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1217arbitrary criteria.
1218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1220a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1221the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1222
1223 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1224 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1225 between responses and new requests.
1226
1227 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1228 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1229 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1230 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1231
1232 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1233 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1234 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1235
1236 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1237 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1238 client-facing connection remains open.
1239
1240 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1241 after the end of the response.
1242
1243The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1244frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1245following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1246weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1247
1248 Backend mode
1249
1250 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1255 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1256 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1257 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1258 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1265--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001267The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1268limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1269they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1270limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001272option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001273and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1274with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1275specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001277
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1279------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1280acl - X X X
1281appsession - - X X
1282backlog X X X -
1283balance X - X X
1284bind - X X -
1285bind-process X X X X
1286block - X X X
1287capture cookie - X X -
1288capture request header - X X -
1289capture response header - X X -
1290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1293cookie X - X X
1294default-server X - X X
1295default_backend X X X -
1296description - X X X
1297disabled X X X X
1298dispatch - - X X
1299enabled X X X X
1300errorfile X X X X
1301errorloc X X X X
1302errorloc302 X X X X
1303-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1304errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001305force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306fullconn X - X X
1307grace X X X X
1308hash-type X - X X
1309http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001310http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001311http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001313http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001314http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001316ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001317log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001318max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319maxconn X X X -
1320mode X X X X
1321monitor fail - X X -
1322monitor-net X X X -
1323monitor-uri X X X -
1324option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1325option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1326option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1327option allbackups (*) X - X X
1328option checkcache (*) X - X X
1329option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1330option contstats (*) X X X -
1331option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1332option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1333option forceclose (*) X X X X
1334-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1335option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001336option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001337option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001338option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001339option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001340option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001341option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1342option httpchk X - X X
1343option httpclose (*) X X X X
1344option httplog X X X X
1345option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001346option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001347option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001348option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1350option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1351option logasap (*) X X X -
1352option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001353option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354option nolinger (*) X X X X
1355option originalto X X X X
1356option persist (*) X - X X
1357option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001358option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option smtpchk X - X X
1360option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1361option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1362option splice-request (*) X X X X
1363option splice-response (*) X X X X
1364option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1365option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1366-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001367option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1369option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1370option tcpka X X X X
1371option tcplog X X X X
1372option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001373external-check command X - X X
1374external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1376rate-limit sessions X X X -
1377redirect - X X X
1378redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1379redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1380reqadd - X X X
1381reqallow - X X X
1382reqdel - X X X
1383reqdeny - X X X
1384reqiallow - X X X
1385reqidel - X X X
1386reqideny - X X X
1387reqipass - X X X
1388reqirep - X X X
1389reqisetbe - X X X
1390reqitarpit - X X X
1391reqpass - X X X
1392reqrep - X X X
1393-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1394reqsetbe - X X X
1395reqtarpit - X X X
1396retries X - X X
1397rspadd - X X X
1398rspdel - X X X
1399rspdeny - X X X
1400rspidel - X X X
1401rspideny - X X X
1402rspirep - X X X
1403rsprep - X X X
1404server - - X X
1405source X - X X
1406srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001407stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001408stats auth X - X X
1409stats enable X - X X
1410stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001411stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412stats realm X - X X
1413stats refresh X - X X
1414stats scope X - X X
1415stats show-desc X - X X
1416stats show-legends X - X X
1417stats show-node X - X X
1418stats uri X - X X
1419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1420stick match - - X X
1421stick on - - X X
1422stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001423stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001425tcp-check connect - - X X
1426tcp-check expect - - X X
1427tcp-check send - - X X
1428tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001429tcp-request connection - X X -
1430tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001431tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001432tcp-response content - - X X
1433tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434timeout check X - X X
1435timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001436timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001437timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1438timeout connect X - X X
1439timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1440timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1441timeout http-request X X X X
1442timeout queue X - X X
1443timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001444timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001445timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001447timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001449unique-id-format X X X -
1450unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001452use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1454 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1458---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
1460This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1461
1462
1463acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1464 Declare or complete an access list.
1465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1466 no | yes | yes | yes
1467 Example:
1468 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1469 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1470 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1476 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 no | no | yes | yes
1480 Arguments :
1481 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1482 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1483
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001484 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485 checked in each cookie value.
1486
1487 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1488 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1489 milliseconds.
1490
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001491 request-learn
1492 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1493 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1494 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1495 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1496 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1497 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1500 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1501 data following this prefix.
1502
1503 Example :
1504 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1505
1506 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1507 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1508
1509 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1510 2 modes are currently supported :
1511 - path-parameters :
1512 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1513 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1514 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1515 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1516 - query-string :
1517 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1518 query string.
1519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1521 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1522 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1523 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001524 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1525 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1526 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1528 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1529
1530 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1534 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 Example :
1537 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001539 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1540 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
1542
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001543backlog <conns>
1544 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1546 yes | yes | yes | no
1547 Arguments :
1548 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1549 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001550 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001551
1552 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1553 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1554 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1555 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1556 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1557 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1558 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1559 backlog parameter.
1560
1561 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1562 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1563 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1564
1565 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1566
1567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001569balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1572 yes | no | yes | yes
1573 Arguments :
1574 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1575 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1576 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1577 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1578
1579 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1580 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1581 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1582 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001583 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001584 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001585 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1586 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1587 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1588 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1589 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1590 it, so that you don't worry.
1591
1592 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1593 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1594 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1595 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1596 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1597 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1598 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1599 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001601 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1602 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1603 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1604 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1605 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1606 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1607 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1608 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1609
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001610 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001611 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001612 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1613 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001614 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001615 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1616 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1617 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1618 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1619 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1621 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1622 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1623 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1624 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1625 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1628 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1629 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1630 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1631 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1632 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1633 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1634 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001635 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001637 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1638 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1639 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001640
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001641 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1642 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1643 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1644 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1645 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1646 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1647 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1648 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1649 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001654 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001655 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1656 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1657 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1658 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1659 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1660 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1661 URIs start with a leading "/".
1662
1663 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1664 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1665 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1666 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001669 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1670
1671 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001672 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1673 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001674 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1675 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1676 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1677 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001679 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1680 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001681
1682 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1683 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1684 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1685 server will receive the request.
1686
1687 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1688 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1689 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1690 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1691 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001692 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1693 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1694 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001696 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1697 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1698 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1699 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1700 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001703 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1704 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1705 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1706
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1708 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1709 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1710
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001712 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001713 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1714 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1715 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1716 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1717 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1718 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001720 used instead.
1721
1722 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1723 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1724 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1725 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1728 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1729 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1730
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001731 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001734 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1735 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001736
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001737 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1738 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1739 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741 Examples :
1742 balance roundrobin
1743 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001745 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1746 balance hdr(host)
1747 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001748
1749 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1750 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1754 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1755 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1756 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1757
1758 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1759 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1760 defaults to 16 kB.
1761
1762 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1763 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1764
1765 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1766 Round Robin.
1767
1768 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1769 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1770 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1771 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1772
1773 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1774
1775 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001776 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001777 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1778 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1779 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001781 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1782 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783
1784
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001785bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1786bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1789 no | yes | yes | no
1790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001791 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1792 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1793 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1794 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001795 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001796 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1797 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1798 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1799 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001804 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1805 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1806 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001807 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1808 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1809 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1810 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001811
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001812 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1813 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001814 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1815 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1816 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001817 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1818 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1819 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1820 the range.
1821
1822 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1823 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1824 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1825 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1826 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1827 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1828 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001829 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001830 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001831
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001832 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1833 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1834 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1835 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1836 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1837 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1838 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1839 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001841 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1842 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1843 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1844 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001845
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1847 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1848 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1849 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1850 in a frontend.
1851
1852 Example :
1853 listen http_proxy
1854 bind :80,:443
1855 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001856 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001858 listen http_https_proxy
1859 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001860 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001861
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001862 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1863 bind ipv6@:80
1864 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1865 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1866
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001867 listen external_bind_app1
1868 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1869
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001870 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001871 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001872
1873
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001874bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001875 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1877 yes | yes | yes | yes
1878 Arguments :
1879 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1880 may be used to override a default value.
1881
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001882 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001883 option may be combined with other numbers.
1884
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001885 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1887 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1888 missing from all processes.
1889
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001890 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001891 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001892 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1893 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1894 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1895 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896
1897 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1898 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1899 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1900 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1901 and 'even' instances.
1902
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1904 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1905 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1906 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001907
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001908 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1909 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1910
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001911 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1912 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1913
1914 Example :
1915 listen app_ip1
1916 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001917 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001918
1919 listen app_ip2
1920 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001921 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001922
1923 listen management
1924 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001925 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001926
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001927 listen management
1928 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1929 bind-process 1-4
1930
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001931 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001932
1933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934block { if | unless } <condition>
1935 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1937 no | yes | yes | yes
1938
1939 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1940 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001941 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001942 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1944 "block" statements per instance.
1945
1946 Example:
1947 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1948 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1949 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1950 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001952 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
1954
1955capture cookie <name> len <length>
1956 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1958 no | yes | yes | no
1959 Arguments :
1960 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1961 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1962 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1963 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1964 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1965
1966 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1967 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1968 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1969 right if it exceeds <length>.
1970
1971 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1972 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1973 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1974 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1975
1976 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1977 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1978 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1979
1980 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1981 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1982 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001983 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1984 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1985 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986
1987 Example:
1988 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1989
1990 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001991 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
1993
1994capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001995 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1997 no | yes | yes | no
1998 Arguments :
1999 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002000 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2002 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2003 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2004
2005 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2006 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2007 it exceeds <length>.
2008
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002009 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2011 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002012 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2013 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2014 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2015 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002016 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002017 environments to find where the request came from.
2018
2019 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2020 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2021 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2022 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002024 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2025 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2026 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2027 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2028 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
2030 Example:
2031 capture request header Host len 15
2032 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2033 capture request header Referrer len 15
2034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002035 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036 about logging.
2037
2038
2039capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002040 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2042 no | yes | yes | no
2043 Arguments :
2044 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002045 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2047 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2048 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2049
2050 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2051 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2052 it exceeds <length>.
2053
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002054 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2056 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2057 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002058 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2059 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2060 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2061 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002063 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2064 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2065 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2066 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2067 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002068
2069 Example:
2070 capture response header Content-length len 9
2071 capture response header Location len 15
2072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002073 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 about logging.
2075
2076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002077clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | no
2081 Arguments :
2082 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2083 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2084 as explained at the top of this document.
2085
2086 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2087 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2088 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2089 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2090 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2091 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2092 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2093 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002094 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2096 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2097
2098 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2099 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2100 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2101 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2102 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2103 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2104
2105 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2106 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2107
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002108 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2109 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002111compression algo <algorithm> ...
2112compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002113compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002114 Enable HTTP compression.
2115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2116 yes | yes | yes | yes
2117 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002118 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2119 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2120 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2121
2122 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002123 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002124 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2125 data.
2126
2127 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2128 support for zlib was built in.
2129
2130 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2131 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2132 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2133 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2134 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2135 in.
2136
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002137 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002138 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002139 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2140 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2141 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2142 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2143 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002144
2145 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2146 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2147 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2148 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2149 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002150 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2151 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2152 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2153 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2154 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2155 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002156
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002157 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002158 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2159 "Accept-Encoding" header
2160 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002161 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002162 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2163 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002164 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2165 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2166 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2167 "multipart"
2168 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2169 header
2170 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2171 and later
2172 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2173 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2176 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002177
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002178 Examples :
2179 compression algo gzip
2180 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002182contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2185 yes | no | yes | yes
2186 Arguments :
2187 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2188 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2189 as explained at the top of this document.
2190
2191 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002192 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002193 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2195 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2196 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2197 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2198
2199 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2200 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2201 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2202 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2203 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2204 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2205
2206 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2207 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2208 instead.
2209
2210 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2211 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2212
2213
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002214cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002215 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2216 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2219 yes | no | yes | yes
2220 Arguments :
2221 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2222 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2223 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2224 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2225 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2226 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2227 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2228 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2229 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2230
2231 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2232 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2233 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2234 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2235 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2236 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2237 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2238 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2239 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2240 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2241 "insert" and "prefix".
2242
2243 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002244 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002245
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002246 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002247 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2248 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2249 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2250 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2251 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2252 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2253 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2254 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2255 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2256 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002257
2258 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2259 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2260 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2261 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2262 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2263 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2264 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2265 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2266 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2267 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002268 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2269 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2270 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002271
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002272 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2273 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2274 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002275 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2276 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2277 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2278 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002279 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2280 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2281 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
2283 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2284 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2285 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2286 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2287 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2288 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2289 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2290 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2291 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2292
2293 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2294 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2295 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2296 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2297 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2298 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2299 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2300 persistence cookie in the cache.
2301 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2302
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002303 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2304 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2305 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2306 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2307 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2308 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2309 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2310 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2311 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2312 they logout.
2313
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002314 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2315 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2316 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2317 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2318
2319 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2320 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2321 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2322 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2323 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2324 this attribute.
2325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002326 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002327 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002328 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2329 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2330 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2331 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2332 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2333 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002334
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002335 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2336 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2337 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2338 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2339 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2340 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2341 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2342 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2343 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2344 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2345 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2346 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2347 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2348 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2349 the site.
2350
2351 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2352 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2353 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2354 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2355 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2356 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2357 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2358 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2359 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2360 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2361 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2362 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2363 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2364 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2365 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2366 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2369 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2370 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2371 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373 Examples :
2374 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2375 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2376 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002377 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002379 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002380 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002383default-server [param*]
2384 Change default options for a server in a backend
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2386 yes | no | yes | yes
2387 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002388 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2389 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2390 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2391 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002392
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002393 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002394 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2395
2396 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399default_backend <backend>
2400 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2402 yes | yes | yes | no
2403 Arguments :
2404 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2405
2406 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2407 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2408 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2409 will catch all undetermined requests.
2410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411 Example :
2412
2413 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2414 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2415 default_backend dynamic
2416
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002417 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002419
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002420description <string>
2421 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2423 no | yes | yes | yes
2424 Arguments : string
2425
2426 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2427 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2428 it describes.
2429 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2430
2431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432disabled
2433 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2435 yes | yes | yes | yes
2436 Arguments : none
2437
2438 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2439 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2440 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2441 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2442 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2443 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2444 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2445
2446 See also : "enabled"
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002449dispatch <address>:<port>
2450 Set a default server address
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002454
2455 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2456 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2457 during start-up.
2458
2459 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2460 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2461 possible with normal servers.
2462
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002463 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002464 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2465 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2466 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2467 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2468
2469 See also : "server"
2470
2471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472enabled
2473 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | yes | yes | yes
2476 Arguments : none
2477
2478 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2479 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2480
2481 See also : "disabled"
2482
2483
2484errorfile <code> <file>
2485 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 yes | yes | yes | yes
2488 Arguments :
2489 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002490 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
2492 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002493 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002495 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2496 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497
2498 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2499 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2500 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2501
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002502 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2505 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2506 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2507 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2508
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002509 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2510 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2511 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2512 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2513 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2514 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2517 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2518 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002519 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002520 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2521
2522 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2523
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002524 Example :
2525 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002526 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002527 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2528 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002530
2531errorloc <code> <url>
2532errorloc302 <code> <url>
2533 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2535 yes | yes | yes | yes
2536 Arguments :
2537 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002538 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002539
2540 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2541 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2542 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2543 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2544 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2545
2546 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2547 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2548 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2549
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002550 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002552 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2553 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2554 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2555 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2556 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2557 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2558 request.
2559
2560 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2561
2562
2563errorloc303 <code> <url>
2564 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 yes | yes | yes | yes
2567 Arguments :
2568 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2569 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2570
2571 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2572 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2573 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2574 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2575 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2576
2577 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2578 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2579 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2580
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002581 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2584 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2585 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2586 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002587 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002588
2589 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2590
2591
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002592force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2593 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2595 no | yes | yes | yes
2596
2597 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2598 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2599 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2600 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2601 marked down for maintenance operations.
2602
2603 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2604 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2605 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2606 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2607 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2608 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2609 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2610 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2611 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2612
2613 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2614 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2615 is used.
2616
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002617 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002618 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002619
2620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002621fullconn <conns>
2622 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2624 yes | no | yes | yes
2625 Arguments :
2626 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2627 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2628
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002629 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002631 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002632 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2633 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2634 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2635 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2636 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002637 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002639 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2640 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002641 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2642 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2643 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002645 Example :
2646 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2647 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2648 # connections.
2649 backend dynamic
2650 fullconn 10000
2651 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2652 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2653
2654 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2655
2656
2657grace <time>
2658 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002660 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002661 Arguments :
2662 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2663 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2664 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2665
2666 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2667 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002668 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002669 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2670
2671 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2672 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2673 simplify it.
2674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002676hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002677 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | no | yes | yes
2680 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002681 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2682 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002683
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002684 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2685 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2686 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2687 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2688 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2689 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2690 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2691 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2692 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2693 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002694
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002695 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2696 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2697 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2698 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2699 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2700 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2701 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2702 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2703 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2704 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2705 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2706 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2707 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002708 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2709 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002710
2711 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2712
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002713 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002714 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2715 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2716 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002717 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2718 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2719 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002720
2721 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2722 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002723 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2724 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2725 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2726 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2727
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002728 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2729 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2730 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2731 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2732 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2733 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2734 parameter.
2735
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002736 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2737
2738 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2739 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2740 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2741 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2742 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2743 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2744 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2745 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2746 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2747 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2748 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2749 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002750
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002751 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2752 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2753 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002754
2755 See also : "balance", "server"
2756
2757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758http-check disable-on-404
2759 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762 Arguments : none
2763
2764 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2765 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2766 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2767 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2768 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2769 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2770 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2771 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002772 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2773 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2774 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2775
2776 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2777
2778
2779http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002780 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002782 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002783 Arguments :
2784 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2785 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002786 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002787 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2788 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2789 details on the supported keywords.
2790
2791 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2792 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2793 with the usual backslash ('\').
2794
2795 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2796 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2797 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2798 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2799 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2800
2801 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002802 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2804 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2805 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2806
2807 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002808 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002809 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2810 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2811 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2812 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2813
2814 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002815 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002816 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2817 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2818 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2819 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2820 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2821 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2822 trace).
2823
2824 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2827 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2828 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2829 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2830 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2831 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2832
2833 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2834 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2835 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2836 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2837 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2838 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2839 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2840 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2841
2842 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2843 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2844
2845 Examples :
2846 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002847 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002848
2849 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002850 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002851
2852 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002853 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002854
2855 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002856 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002858 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002859
2860
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002861http-check send-state
2862 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2864 yes | no | yes | yes
2865 Arguments : none
2866
2867 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2868 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2869 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2870 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2871 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2872
2873 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2874 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2875 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2876 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2877 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2878 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2879 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2880 checked in multiple backends.
2881
2882 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2883 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2884
2885 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2886 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2887 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2888 one fails.
2889
2890 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2891 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2892 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2893
2894 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2895 server's queue.
2896
2897 Example of a header received by the application server :
2898 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2899 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2900
2901 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2902
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002903http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002904 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002905 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002906 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2907 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002908 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2909 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2910 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2911 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2912 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2913 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002914 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002915 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2916
2917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2918 no | yes | yes | yes
2919
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002920 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2921 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2922 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2923 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2924 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002925
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002926 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2927 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2928 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2929
2930 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2931 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2932 are evaluated.
2933
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002934 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2935 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2936 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2937 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2938 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2939 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2940 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2941 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2942 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002943 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002944 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2945
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002946 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2947 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2948 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2949 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2950 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2951
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002952 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2953 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2954 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002955 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2956 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002957
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002958 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2959 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2960 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2961 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2962 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2963 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2964 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2965 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2966
2967 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2968 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2969 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2970 external users.
2971
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002972 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2973 <name>.
2974
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002975 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2976 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2977 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2978 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2979 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2980 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2981 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2982 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2983
2984 Example:
2985
2986 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2987
2988 applied to:
2989
2990 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2991
2992 outputs:
2993
2994 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2995
2996 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
2997
2998 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
2999 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3000 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3001 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3002 header.
3003
3004 Example:
3005
3006 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3007
3008 applied to:
3009
3010 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3011
3012 outputs:
3013
3014 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3015
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003016 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3017 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3018 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3019 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3020 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3021 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3022 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3023 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3024
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003025 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3026 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3027 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3028 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3029 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3030 another equipment.
3031
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003032 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3033 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3034 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3035 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3036 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3037 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3038 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3039 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3040
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003041 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3042 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3043 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3044 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3045 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3046 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3047 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3048 admin privileges.
3049
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003050 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3051 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3052 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3053 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3054 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3055 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3056 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3057 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3058
3059 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3060 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3061 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3062 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3063 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3064 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3065
3066 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3067 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3068 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3069 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3070 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3071 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3072
3073 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3074 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3075 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3076 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3077 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3078 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3079 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3080 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3081 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3082
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003083 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3084
3085 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3086 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3087 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3088 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003089
3090 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003091 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3092 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3093 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003094
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003095 http-request allow if nagios
3096 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3097 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3098 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003099
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003100 Example:
3101 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003102 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003103
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003104 Example:
3105 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3106 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3107 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3108 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3109 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3110 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3111 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3112 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3113 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3114
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003115 Example:
3116 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3117 acl add path /addacl
3118 acl del path /delacl
3119
3120 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3121
3122 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3123 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3124
3125 Example:
3126 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3127 acl setmap path /setmap
3128 acl delmap path /delmap
3129
3130 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3131
3132 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3133 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3134
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003135 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3136 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003137
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003138http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003139 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003140 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3141 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003142 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3143 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3144 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3145 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3146 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3147 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003149 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3150
3151 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3152 no | yes | yes | yes
3153
3154 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3155 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3156 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3157 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3158 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3159 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3160
3161 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3162 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3163 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3164 current section.
3165
3166 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3167 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3168 rules are evaluated.
3169
3170 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3171 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3172 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3173 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3174 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3175 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3176 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3177
3178 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3179 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3180 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3181 external users.
3182
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003183 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3184 <name>.
3185
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003186 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3187 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3188 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3189 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3190 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3191 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3192 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3193 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3194
3195 Example:
3196
3197 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3198
3199 applied to:
3200
3201 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3202
3203 outputs:
3204
3205 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3206
3207 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3208
3209 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3210 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3211 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3212 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3213 header.
3214
3215 Example:
3216
3217 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3218
3219 applied to:
3220
3221 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3222
3223 outputs:
3224
3225 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3226
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003227 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3228 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3229 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3230 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3231 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3232 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3233 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3234 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3235
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003236 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3237 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3238 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3239 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3240 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3241 another equipment.
3242
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003243 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3244 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3245 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3246 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3247 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3248 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3249 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3250 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3251
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003252 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3253 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3254 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3255 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3256 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3257 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3258 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3259 admin privileges.
3260
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003261 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3262 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3263 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3264 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3265 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3266 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3267 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3268 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3269
3270 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3271 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3272 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3273 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3274 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3275 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3276
3277 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3278 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3279 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3280 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3281 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3282 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3283
3284 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3285 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3286 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3287 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3288 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3289 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3290 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3291 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3292 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3293
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003294 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3295
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003296 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003297 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3298 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3299 rules.
3300
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003301 Example:
3302 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3303
3304 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3305
3306 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3307 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3308
3309 Example:
3310 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3311
3312 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3313
3314 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3315 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3316
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003317 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3318 ACL usage.
3319
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003320
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003321http-send-name-header [<header>]
3322 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3323
3324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3325 yes | no | yes | yes
3326
3327 Arguments :
3328
3329 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3330
3331 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3332 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3333 is added with the header string proved.
3334
3335 See also : "server"
3336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003337id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003338 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3340 no | yes | yes | yes
3341 Arguments : none
3342
3343 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3344 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3345 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003346
3347
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003348ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3349 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 no | yes | yes | yes
3352
3353 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3354 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3355 and running).
3356
3357 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3358 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3359 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003360 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003361 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3362
3363 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3364 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3365
3366 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3367 "unless" condition is met.
3368
3369 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3370
3371
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003372log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003373log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003374no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003378
3379 Prefix :
3380 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3381 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3382 prefix does not allow arguments.
3383
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003384 Arguments :
3385 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3386 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3387 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3388 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3389 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3390 parameter.
3391
3392 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3393 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3394
3395 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3396 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3397 standard syslog port).
3398
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003399 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3400 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3401 standard syslog port).
3402
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003403 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3404 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3405 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3406 appropriately writeable).
3407
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003408 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3409 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3410 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3411 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3412
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003413 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3414 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3415 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3416 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3417 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3418 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3419 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3420 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3421 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3422 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3423 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3426
3427 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3428 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3429 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3430
3431 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3432 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3433 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003434 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3435 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3436 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3437 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3438 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003439
3440 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3441
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003442 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3443 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3444 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003445
3446 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3447 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3448 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3449 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3450
3451 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3452 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003453
3454 Example :
3455 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003456 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3457 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003458 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3459
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003460
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003461log-format <string>
3462 Allows you to custom a log line.
3463
3464 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003466
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003467max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3468 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 yes | no | yes | yes
3471
3472 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3473 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3474 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3475 servers.
3476
3477 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3478 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3479 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3480 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3481 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3482 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3483 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3484 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3485 picking a different server.
3486
3487 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3488 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3489 even if they have to be queued.
3490
3491 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3492 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3493
3494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495maxconn <conns>
3496 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | yes | yes | no
3499 Arguments :
3500 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3501 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3502 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3503 closes.
3504
3505 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3506 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3507 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3508 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3509 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3510 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3511 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3512 properly tuned.
3513
3514 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3515 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3516 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3517
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003518 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3519
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003520 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3521
3522
3523mode { tcp|http|health }
3524 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | yes
3527 Arguments :
3528 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3529 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3530 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3531 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3532
3533 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3534 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3535 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3536 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3537 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3538
3539 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003540 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3541 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3542 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3543 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3544 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3545 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3546 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003547
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003548 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3549 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3550 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003551
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003552 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553 defaults http_instances
3554 mode http
3555
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003556 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003558
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003559monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3562 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563 Arguments :
3564 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3565 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003566 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3568 backend and its backup.
3569
3570 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3571 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3572 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3573 servers in a list of backends.
3574
3575 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3576 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3577 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3578 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3579 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3580 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3581 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003582 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3583 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584
3585 Example:
3586 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3589 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3590 monitor-uri /site_alive
3591 monitor fail if site_dead
3592
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003593 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
3595
3596monitor-net <source>
3597 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | yes | yes | no
3600 Arguments :
3601 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3602 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3603 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3604 followed by a mask.
3605
3606 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3607 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003608 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003609 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3610
3611 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3612 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3613 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3614 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003615 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3616 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3617 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003618
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003619 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3620 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3621 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3622 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3623 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3624 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003626 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3627 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003628
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003629 Example :
3630 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3631 frontend www
3632 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3633
3634 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3635
3636
3637monitor-uri <uri>
3638 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | yes | yes | no
3641 Arguments :
3642 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3643 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3644
3645 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3646 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3647 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3648 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3649 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3650 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3651 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3652 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3653
3654 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3655 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3656 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3657 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3658 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3659 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3660
3661 Example :
3662 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3663 frontend www
3664 mode http
3665 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3666
3667 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003670option abortonclose
3671no option abortonclose
3672 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | no | yes | yes
3675 Arguments : none
3676
3677 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3678 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3679 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3680 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003681 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003682 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3683 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3684 encountered while delivering the response.
3685
3686 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3687 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3688 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3689 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3690 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3691 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003692 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003693 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003694 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3696 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3697 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3698
3699 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3700 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3701 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3702 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3703 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3704 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3705 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3706 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003707 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003708
3709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3711
3712 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3713
3714
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003715option accept-invalid-http-request
3716no option accept-invalid-http-request
3717 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | no
3720 Arguments : none
3721
3722 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3723 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3724 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3725 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3726 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3727 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3728 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3729 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003730 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3731 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3732 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3733 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3734 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3735 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003736
3737 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3738 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3739 been confirmed.
3740
3741 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3742 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003743 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3744 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003745 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3746
3747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3749
3750 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3751 stats socket.
3752
3753
3754option accept-invalid-http-response
3755no option accept-invalid-http-response
3756 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 yes | no | yes | yes
3759 Arguments : none
3760
3761 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3762 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3763 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3764 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3765 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3766 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3767 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3768 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3769 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3770
3771 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3772 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3773 been confirmed.
3774
3775 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3776 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3777 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3778 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3779
3780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3782
3783 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3784 stats socket.
3785
3786
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003787option allbackups
3788no option allbackups
3789 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3791 yes | no | yes | yes
3792 Arguments : none
3793
3794 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3795 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3796 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3797 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3798 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3799 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3800 order between the backup servers anymore.
3801
3802 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3803 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3804
3805 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3806 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3807
3808
3809option checkcache
3810no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003811 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | no | yes | yes
3814 Arguments : none
3815
3816 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3817 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003818 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003819 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3820 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003821 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003822
3823 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003824 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003825 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003826 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3827 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003828 to the client are :
3829 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003830 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003831 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003832 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3833 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3834 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3835 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3836 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3837 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3838 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3839 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3840 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3841 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3842 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3843
3844 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003845 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003846 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003847 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3849
3850 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3851 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003852 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003853 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3854
3855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3857
3858
3859option clitcpka
3860no option clitcpka
3861 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | yes | yes | no
3864 Arguments : none
3865
3866 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3867 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3868 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3869 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3870
3871 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3872 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3873 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3874 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3875
3876 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3877 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3878 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3879 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3880 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3881
3882 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3883
3884 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3885 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3886 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3887
3888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3890
3891 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3892
3893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003894option contstats
3895 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 yes | yes | yes | no
3898 Arguments : none
3899
3900 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3901 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3902 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3903 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3904 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3905 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3906 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3907
3908
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003909option dontlog-normal
3910no option dontlog-normal
3911 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3913 yes | yes | yes | no
3914 Arguments : none
3915
3916 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3917 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3918 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3919 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3920 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3921 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3922 logged.
3923
3924 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3925 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3926 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003928 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003929 logging.
3930
3931
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003932option dontlognull
3933no option dontlognull
3934 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | yes | yes | no
3937 Arguments : none
3938
3939 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3940 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3941 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3942 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3943 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3944 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3945 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3946
3947 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3948 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3949 would not be logged.
3950
3951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003954 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003955
3956
3957option forceclose
3958no option forceclose
3959 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003962 Arguments : none
3963
3964 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3965 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3966 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3967 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3968 global session times in the logs.
3969
3970 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003971 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003972 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003973
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003974 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3975 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3976 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3977
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003978 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3979 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003980
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3983
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003984 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003985
3986
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003987option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003988 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | yes | yes | yes
3991 Arguments :
3992 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3993 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003994 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003995 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003996
3997 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3998 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3999 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4000 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4001 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4002 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4003 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004004 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4005 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4006 possible that the client has already brought one.
4007
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004008 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004009 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004010 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4011 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004012 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4013 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004014
4015 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4016 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4017 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4018 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4019 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4020 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4021 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4022
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004023 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4024 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4025 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4026 are under the control of the end-user.
4027
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004028 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004029 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4030 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004031 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4032 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4033 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004034
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004035 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004036 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4037 frontend www
4038 mode http
4039 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4040
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004041 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4042 backend www
4043 mode http
4044 option forwardfor header X-Client
4045
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004046 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004047 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004048
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004049
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004050option http-keep-alive
4051no option http-keep-alive
4052 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 yes | yes | yes | yes
4055 Arguments : none
4056
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004057 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4058 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4059 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4060 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4061 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4062 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4063 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4064
4065 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4066 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004067 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4068 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4069 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4070 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4071 situations where this option may be useful :
4072
4073 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4074 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4075
4076 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4077 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4078
4079 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4080 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4081 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4082 request.
4083
4084 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4085 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004086 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4087 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4088 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004089
4090 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4091 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4092
4093 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4094 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4095 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4096 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4097 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4098 not set.
4099
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004100 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4101 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004102 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004103 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004104
4105 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004106 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4107 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004108
4109
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004110option http-no-delay
4111no option http-no-delay
4112 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4114 yes | yes | yes | yes
4115 Arguments : none
4116
4117 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4118 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4119 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4120 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4121 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4122 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4123 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4124 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4125 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4126 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4127 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4128 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4129 affected.
4130
4131 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4132 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4133 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4134 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4135 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4136 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4137 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4138 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4139 latency environments.
4140
4141
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004142option http-pretend-keepalive
4143no option http-pretend-keepalive
4144 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4146 yes | yes | yes | yes
4147 Arguments : none
4148
4149 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4150 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4151 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4152 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4153 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4154 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4155 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4156 consider the response complete.
4157
4158 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4159 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4160 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4161 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4162 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4163 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4164
4165 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4166 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4167 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4168 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4169 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4170 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4171 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4172
4173 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4174 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004175 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004176 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4177 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004178
4179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4181
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004182 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4183 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004184
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004185
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004186option http-server-close
4187no option http-server-close
4188 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4190 yes | yes | yes | yes
4191 Arguments : none
4192
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004193 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4194 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4195 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4196 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4197 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4198 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4199 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4200 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4201 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4202 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4203 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4204 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4205 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4206 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4207 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4208 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004209
4210 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4211 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4212 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4213 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004214 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4215 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004216
4217 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4218 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004219 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4220 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004221 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4222 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004223
4224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4226
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004227 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004228 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4229 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004230
4231
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004232option http-tunnel
4233no option http-tunnel
4234 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4236 yes | yes | yes | yes
4237 Arguments : none
4238
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004239 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4240 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4241 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4242 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4243 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4244 "option http-tunnel".
4245
4246 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004247 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004248 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4249 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4250 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4251 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4252 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4253 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4254 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004255
4256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4258
4259 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4260 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4261 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4262
4263
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004264option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004265no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004266 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | yes | yes | no
4269 Arguments : none
4270
4271 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4272 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4273 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4274 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4275 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4276 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4277 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4278
4279 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4280 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4281 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4282 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4283 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4284 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4285 request along its whole life.
4286
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004287 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4288 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4289 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4290 front of an existing proxy.
4291
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004292 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4293
4294 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4295 http-server-close".
4296
4297
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004298option httpchk
4299option httpchk <uri>
4300option httpchk <method> <uri>
4301option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4302 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | no | yes | yes
4305 Arguments :
4306 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4307 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4308 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4309 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4310 ones.
4311
4312 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4313 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4314 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4315
4316 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4317 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4318 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4319 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4320 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4321
4322 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4323 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4324 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4325 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4326 the lack of any response.
4327
4328 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4329
4330 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4331 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4332 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4333
4334 Examples :
4335 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4336 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4337 backend https_relay
4338 mode tcp
4339 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4340 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4341
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004342 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4343 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4344 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004345
4346
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004347option httpclose
4348no option httpclose
4349 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4351 yes | yes | yes | yes
4352 Arguments : none
4353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004354 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4355 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4356 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4357 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004358 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004359 "option http-tunnel".
4360
4361 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4362 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4363 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4364 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4365 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4366 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4367 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4368 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004369
4370 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004371 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004372 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4373 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4374 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4375 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4376 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004377
4378 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4379 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004380 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4381 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004382 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4383 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004384
4385 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4386 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4387
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004388 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4389 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004390
4391
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004392option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004393 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4395 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004396 Arguments :
4397 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4398 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4399 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4400 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4401 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004402
4403 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4404 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4405 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4406 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4407 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4408 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4409 ports.
4410
4411 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4412
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4415 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4416 by default.
4417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004418 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004419
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004420
4421option http_proxy
4422no option http_proxy
4423 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 yes | yes | yes | yes
4426 Arguments : none
4427
4428 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4429 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4430 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4431 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4432 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4433
4434 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4435 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4436 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4437 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004438 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004439 be analyzed.
4440
4441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4443
4444 Example :
4445 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4446 backend direct_forward
4447 option httpclose
4448 option http_proxy
4449
4450 See also : "option httpclose"
4451
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004452
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004453option independent-streams
4454no option independent-streams
4455 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4457 yes | yes | yes | yes
4458 Arguments : none
4459
4460 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4461 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4462 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4463 receive data or not.
4464
4465 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4466 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4467 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4468 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4469 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4470 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4471 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4472 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4473 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4474 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4475 socket buffers.
4476
4477 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4478 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4479 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4480 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4481 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4482
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004483 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004484 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4485 deprecated.
4486
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004487 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004488
4489
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004490option ldap-check
4491 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4493 yes | no | yes | yes
4494 Arguments : none
4495
4496 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4497 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4498 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4499 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4500
4501 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4502 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4503
4504 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4505 configure it.
4506
4507 Example :
4508 option ldap-check
4509
4510 See also : "option httpchk"
4511
4512
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004513option external-check
4514 Use external processes for server health checks
4515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | no | yes | yes
4517
4518 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4519 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4520 command".
4521
4522 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4523
4524 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4525
4526
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004527option log-health-checks
4528no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004529 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 yes | no | yes | yes
4532 Arguments : none
4533
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004534 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4535 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4536 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004537
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004538 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4539 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4540 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4541 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4542 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4543
4544 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4545 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004546
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004547 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4548 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4549 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004550
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004551
4552option log-separate-errors
4553no option log-separate-errors
4554 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | yes | yes | no
4557 Arguments : none
4558
4559 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4560 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4561 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4562 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4563 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4564 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4565 provides very important information.
4566
4567 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4568 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4569 error logs.
4570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004571 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004572 logging.
4573
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004574
4575option logasap
4576no option logasap
4577 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | no
4580 Arguments : none
4581
4582 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4583 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4584 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4585 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4586 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4587 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4588 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004589 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004590 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4591 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4592
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004593 Examples :
4594 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4595 mode http
4596 option httplog
4597 option logasap
4598 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4599
4600 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4601 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4602 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4603 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004605 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004606 logging.
4607
4608
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004609option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004610 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004613 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004614 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4615 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004616 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004617
4618 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4619 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4620 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4621 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4622 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4623 in the MySQL table, like this :
4624
4625 USE mysql;
4626 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4627 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4628
4629 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4630 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4631 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4632 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4633 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4634 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4635 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4636 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4637 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4638
4639 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4640 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004641
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004642 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004643
4644 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4645 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4646 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4647 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4648 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4649 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4650
4651 See also: "option httpchk"
4652
4653
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004654option nolinger
4655no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004656 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004659 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004660
4661 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4662 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4663 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4664 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4665 connections.
4666
4667 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4668 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4669 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4670 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4671 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4672 this too.
4673
4674 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4675 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4676 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4677
4678 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4679 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4680 for servers.
4681
4682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4684
4685
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004686option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4687 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 yes | yes | yes | yes
4690 Arguments :
4691 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4692 matching <network>
4693 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4694 header name.
4695
4696 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4697 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4698 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4699 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4700 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4701 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4702 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4703 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4704 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4705 possible that the client has already brought one.
4706
4707 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4708 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4709 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4710 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4711 header and requires different one.
4712
4713 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4714 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4715 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4716 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4717 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4718 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4719 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4720
4721 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4722 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4723 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4724 both are defined.
4725
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004726 Examples :
4727 # Original Destination address
4728 frontend www
4729 mode http
4730 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4731
4732 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4733 backend www
4734 mode http
4735 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4736
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004737 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4738 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004739
4740
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004741option persist
4742no option persist
4743 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004746 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004747
4748 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4749 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4750 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4751 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4752 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4753 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4754 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4755 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4756 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4757 redirected to another valid server.
4758
4759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4761
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004762 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004763
4764
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004765option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4766 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 yes | no | yes | yes
4769 Arguments :
4770 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4771 PostgreSQL server.
4772
4773 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4774 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4775 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4776 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4777
4778 See also: "option httpchk"
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004781option prefer-last-server
4782no option prefer-last-server
4783 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | no | yes | yes
4786 Arguments : none
4787
4788 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4789 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4790 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4791 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4792 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4793 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4794 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4795 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4796 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004797 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4798 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4799 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4800 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4801 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4802 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4803 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004804
4805 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4806 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4807
4808 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4809
4810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004811option redispatch
4812no option redispatch
4813 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004816 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004817
4818 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4819 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4820 be able to access the service anymore.
4821
4822 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4823 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4824
4825 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4826 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4827 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004829 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4830 "redisp" keywords.
4831
4832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4834
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004835 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004836
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004837
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004838option redis-check
4839 Use redis health checks for server testing
4840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 yes | no | yes | yes
4842 Arguments : none
4843
4844 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4845 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4846 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4847 find the "+PONG" response message.
4848
4849 Example :
4850 option redis-check
4851
4852 See also : "option httpchk"
4853
4854
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004855option smtpchk
4856option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4857 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004860 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004861 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4862 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4863 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4864
4865 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4866 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4867 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4868
4869 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4870 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4871 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4872 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4873 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4874 dead server.
4875
4876 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4877 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4878 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4879 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4880
4881 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4882 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4883 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4884 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4885 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4886
4887 Example :
4888 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4889
4890 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004893option socket-stats
4894no option socket-stats
4895
4896 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | no
4899
4900 Arguments : none
4901
4902
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004903option splice-auto
4904no option splice-auto
4905 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | yes | yes | yes
4908 Arguments : none
4909
4910 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4911 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4912 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4913 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004914 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004915 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4916 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4917 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4918 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4919
4920 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4921 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4922 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4923 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4924 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4925 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4926 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4927 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4928 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4929 keyword.
4930
4931 Example :
4932 option splice-auto
4933
4934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4936
4937 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4938 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4939
4940
4941option splice-request
4942no option splice-request
4943 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 yes | yes | yes | yes
4946 Arguments : none
4947
4948 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004949 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004950 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4951 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4952 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4953 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4954
4955 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4956
4957 Example :
4958 option splice-request
4959
4960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4962
4963 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4964 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4965
4966
4967option splice-response
4968no option splice-response
4969 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | yes
4972 Arguments : none
4973
4974 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004975 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004976 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4977 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4978 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4979 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4980
4981 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4982
4983 Example :
4984 option splice-response
4985
4986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4988
4989 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4990 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4991
4992
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004993option srvtcpka
4994no option srvtcpka
4995 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | no | yes | yes
4998 Arguments : none
4999
5000 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5001 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5002 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5003 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5004
5005 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5006 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5007 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5008 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5009
5010 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5011 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5012 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5013 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5014 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5015
5016 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5017
5018 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5019 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5020 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5021
5022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5024
5025 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5026
5027
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005028option ssl-hello-chk
5029 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5031 yes | no | yes | yes
5032 Arguments : none
5033
5034 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5035 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5036 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5037 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5038 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5039 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5040 hello message.
5041
5042 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5043 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5044 messages, which is appreciable.
5045
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005046 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5047 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5048 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005049
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005050 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5051
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005052
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005053option tcp-check
5054 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5056 yes | no | yes | yes
5057
5058 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5059 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5060
5061 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5062 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5063 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5064
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005065 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005066 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5067 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5068 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5069 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5070 only.
5071
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005072 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005073 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5074 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5075 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5076 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5077
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005078 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005079 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5080 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005081 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005082 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5083 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5084 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5085 the respective protocols.
5086 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5087 analysed.
5088
5089 Examples :
5090 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5091 option tcp-check
5092 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5093
5094 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5095 option tcp-check
5096 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5097
5098 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5099 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005100 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005101 option tcp-check
5102 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5103 tcp-check expect +PONG
5104 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5105 tcp-check expect string role:master
5106 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5107 tcp-check expect string +OK
5108
5109 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5110 (send many headers before analyzing)
5111 option tcp-check
5112 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5113 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5114 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5115 tcp-check send \r\n
5116 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5117
5118
5119 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5120
5121
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005122option tcp-smart-accept
5123no option tcp-smart-accept
5124 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | yes | yes | no
5127 Arguments : none
5128
5129 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5130 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5131 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5132 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5133 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5134 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5135
5136 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5137 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5138 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5139 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5140
5141 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5142 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5143 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5144 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5145
5146 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5147 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5148 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5149
5150 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5151 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5152 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5153
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005154 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5155
5156
5157option tcp-smart-connect
5158no option tcp-smart-connect
5159 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | no | yes | yes
5162 Arguments : none
5163
5164 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5165 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5166 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5167 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5168 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5169
5170 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5171 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5172 complex.
5173
5174 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5175 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5176 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5177
5178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5180
5181 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5182
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005183
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005184option tcpka
5185 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | yes | yes | yes
5188 Arguments : none
5189
5190 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5191 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5192 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5193 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5194
5195 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5196 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5197 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5198 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5199
5200 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5201 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5202 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5203 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5204 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5205
5206 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5207
5208 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5209 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5210 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5211 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5212 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5213 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5214 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5215 backends.
5216
5217 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5218
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005219
5220option tcplog
5221 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | yes | yes | yes
5224 Arguments : none
5225
5226 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5227 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5228 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5229 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5230 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5231 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5232 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5233 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5234
5235 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005237 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005238
5239
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005240option transparent
5241no option transparent
5242 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005244 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005245 Arguments : none
5246
5247 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5248 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5249 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5250 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5251 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5252 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5253 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5254 appropriate server.
5255
5256 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5257 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5258
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005259 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005260 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005261
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005262
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005263external-check command <command>
5264 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267
5268 Arguments :
5269 <command> is the external command to run
5270
5271 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5272 command may be set using "external-check path".
5273
5274 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5275
5276 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5277
5278 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5279 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5280 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5281 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5282 be the string "NOT_USED".
5283
5284 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5285 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5286 failed.
5287
5288 Example :
5289 external-check command /bin/true
5290
5291 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5292
5293
5294external-check path <path>
5295 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5297 yes | no | yes | yes
5298
5299 Arguments :
5300 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5301
5302 The default path is "".
5303
5304 Example :
5305 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5306
5307 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5308 "external-check command"
5309
5310
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005311persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005312persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005313 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 yes | no | yes | yes
5316 Arguments :
5317 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005318 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5319 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005320
5321 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5322 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5323 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5324 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5325 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5326 forwarded to this server.
5327
5328 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5329 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5330 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005331 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005332 a single "listen" section.
5333
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005334 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5335 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5336 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5337
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005338 Example :
5339 listen tse-farm
5340 bind :3389
5341 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5342 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5343 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5344 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5345 persist rdp-cookie
5346 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005347 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005348 balance rdp-cookie
5349 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5350 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5351
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005352 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5353 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005354
5355
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005356rate-limit sessions <rate>
5357 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | yes | yes | no
5360 Arguments :
5361 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5362 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5363
5364 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5365 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5366 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5367 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5368 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5369 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5370
5371 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5372 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5373 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5374 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5375
5376 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5377 listen smtp
5378 mode tcp
5379 bind :25
5380 rate-limit sessions 10
5381 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5382
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005383 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5384 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5385 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005386
5387 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5388
5389
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005390redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5391redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5392redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005393 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 no | yes | yes | yes
5396
5397 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005398 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005399
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005401 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005402 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5403 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5404 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005405
5406 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5407 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5408 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5409 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5410 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005411 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5412 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5413 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5414 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005415
5416 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5417 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5418 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5419 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5420 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5421 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005422 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005423 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005424 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5425 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5426 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005427
5428 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005429 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5430 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5431 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5432 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5433 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5434 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5435 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5436 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005437
5438 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5439 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5440
5441 - "drop-query"
5442 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5443 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5444 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5445 with a location-type redirect.
5446
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005447 - "append-slash"
5448 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5449 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5450 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5451 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5452
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005453 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5454 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5455 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5456 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5457 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5458 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5459 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5460
5461 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5462 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5463 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5464 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5465 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5466 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5467 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005468
5469 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5470 acl clear dst_port 80
5471 acl secure dst_port 8080
5472 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005473 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005474 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005475 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5476
5477 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005478 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5479 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5480 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005481 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005482
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005483 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5484 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5485 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5486
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005487 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005488 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005489
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005490 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5491 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5492 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005494 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005495
5496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005497redisp (deprecated)
5498redispatch (deprecated)
5499 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005502 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005503
5504 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5505 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5506 be able to access the service anymore.
5507
5508 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5509 redistribute them to a working server.
5510
5511 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5512 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5513 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005515 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5516 "option redispatch" instead.
5517
5518 See also : "option redispatch"
5519
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005520
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005521reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 no | yes | yes | yes
5525 Arguments :
5526 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5527 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005528 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005530 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5531 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5532
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005533 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5534 the last header of an HTTP request.
5535
5536 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5537 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5538 responses.
5539
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005540 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5541 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5542 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5543
5544 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5545 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546
5547
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005548reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5549reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005550 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 no | yes | yes | yes
5553 Arguments :
5554 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5555 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5556 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5557 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5558 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5559 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5560 ignores case.
5561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005562 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5563 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5564
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005565 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5566 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5567 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5568 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005569 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570
5571 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5572 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5573
5574 Example :
5575 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5576 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5577 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5578
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005579 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5580 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005581
5582
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005583reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5584reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005585 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 no | yes | yes | yes
5588 Arguments :
5589 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5590 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5591 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5592 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5593 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5594 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5595
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005596 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5597 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5598
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005599 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5600 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5601 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5602 next servers.
5603
5604 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5605 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5606 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5607
5608 Example :
5609 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5610 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5611 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005613 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5614 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005615
5616
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005617reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5618reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005619 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 no | yes | yes | yes
5622 Arguments :
5623 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5624 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5625 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5626 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5627 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5628 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5629 case.
5630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005631 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5632 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5633
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005634 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5635 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5636 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5637 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005638 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005639
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005640 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005641 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005642 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005643
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005644 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5645 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5646
5647 Example :
5648 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5649 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5650 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5651
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005652 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5653 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005654
5655
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005656reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5657reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 no | yes | yes | yes
5661 Arguments :
5662 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5663 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5664 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5665 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5666 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5667 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5668 case.
5669
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005670 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5671 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5672
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005673 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5674 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5675 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5676 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5677
5678 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5679 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5680
5681 Example :
5682 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5683 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5684 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5685 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5686
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005687 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5688 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689
5690
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005691reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5692reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005693 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5695 no | yes | yes | yes
5696 Arguments :
5697 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5698 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5699 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5700 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5701 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5702 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5703
5704 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5705 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5706 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5707 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005708 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005710 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5711 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5712
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005713 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5714 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5715 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5716
5717 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5718 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5719 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5720 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5721 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5722
5723 Example :
5724 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005725 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005726 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5727 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5728
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005729 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5730 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005731
5732
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005733reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5734reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005735 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 no | yes | yes | yes
5738 Arguments :
5739 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5740 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5741 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5742 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5743 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5744 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5745 ignores case.
5746
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005747 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5748 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5749
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005750 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5751 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005752 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5753 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5754 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005755 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5756 not set.
5757
5758 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5759 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5760 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5761 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5762 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5763
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005764 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005765 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5766 # block all others.
5767 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5768 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005770 # block bad guys
5771 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5772 reqitarpit . if badguys
5773
5774 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5775 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005776
5777
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005778retries <value>
5779 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | no | yes | yes
5782 Arguments :
5783 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5784 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5785 default value is 3.
5786
5787 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5788 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5789 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5790
5791 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5792 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5793
5794 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5795 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5796
5797 See also : "option redispatch"
5798
5799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005800rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 no | yes | yes | yes
5804 Arguments :
5805 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5806 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005807 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005808
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005809 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5810 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5811
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005812 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5813 the last header of an HTTP response.
5814
5815 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5816 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5817 responses.
5818
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005819 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5820 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005821
5822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005823rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5824rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005825 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 no | yes | yes | yes
5828 Arguments :
5829 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5830 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5831 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5832 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5833 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5834 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5835 ignores case.
5836
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005837 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5838 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5839
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005840 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5841 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005842 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005843 client.
5844
5845 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5846 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5847 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5848
5849 Example :
5850 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005851 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005852
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005853 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5854 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005855
5856
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005857rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5858rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005859 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5861 no | yes | yes | yes
5862 Arguments :
5863 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5864 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5865 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5866 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5867 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5868 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5869 ignores case.
5870
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005871 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5872 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5873
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005874 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5875 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5876 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5877 case-sensitive.
5878
5879 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005880 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5881 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5882 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005883
5884 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5885 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5886
5887 Example :
5888 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5889 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005891 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5892 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005893
5894
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005895rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5896rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005897 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 no | yes | yes | yes
5900 Arguments :
5901 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5902 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5903 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5904 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5905 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5906 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5907 ignores case.
5908
5909 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5910 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5911 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5912 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005913 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005914
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005915 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5916 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5917
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005918 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5919 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5920 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5921
5922 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5923 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5924 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5925 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5926 are not case-sensitive.
5927
5928 Example :
5929 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5930 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5931
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005932 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5933 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005934
5935
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005936server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005937 Declare a server in a backend
5938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5939 no | no | yes | yes
5940 Arguments :
5941 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005942 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005943 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005945 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5946 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5947 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5948 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005949 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5950 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5951 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5952 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5953 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005954 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5955 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5956 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5957 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5958 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5959 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5960 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005961 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005962 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5963 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5964 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5965 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005967 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005968 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5969 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5970 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5971 adding this value to the client's port.
5972
5973 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5974 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005975 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005976
5977 Examples :
5978 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5979 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005980 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005981 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5982 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5983 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005984
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005985 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5986 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005987
5988
5989source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005990source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005991source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005992 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | no | yes | yes
5995 Arguments :
5996 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5997 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005998
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005999 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006000 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6001 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6002 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6003 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6004 supported prefixes are :
6005 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6006 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6007 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006008 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006009 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6010 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6011 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6012 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006013
6014 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6015 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006016 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6017 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6018 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006019
6020 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6021 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6022 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6023 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6024 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6025 <addr>.
6026
6027 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6028 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6029 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6030 port.
6031
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006032 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6033 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6034 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6035 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006036 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006037 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6038 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6039 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6040 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6041 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6042 HTTP header.
6043
6044 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6045 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006046 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006047 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6048 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6049 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6050 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6051 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6052 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6053 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6054
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006055 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6056 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6057 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6058 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6059 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6060 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6061
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006062 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6063 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6064 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6065 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6066
6067 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6068 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6069 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6070 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6071 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6072 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6073
6074 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6075 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6076 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6077 there are two methods :
6078
6079 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6080 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6081 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6082 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6083 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6084 of the client ranges may be used.
6085
6086 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6087 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6088 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6089 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6090 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6091 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6092 same session.
6093
6094 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6095 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6096 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6097 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6098 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6099 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6100
6101 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6102 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6103 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006104 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006105
6106 Examples :
6107 backend private
6108 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6109 source 192.168.1.200
6110
6111 backend transparent_ssl1
6112 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6113 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6114
6115 backend transparent_ssl2
6116 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6117 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6118 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6119
6120 backend transparent_ssl3
6121 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6122 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6123 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6124
6125 backend transparent_smtp
6126 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6127 # with Tproxy version 4.
6128 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6129
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006130 backend transparent_http
6131 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6132 # proxy.
6133 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006135 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006136 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006138
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006139srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6140 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6142 yes | no | yes | yes
6143 Arguments :
6144 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6145 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6146 as explained at the top of this document.
6147
6148 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6149 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6150 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6151 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6152 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6153 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6154 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6155
6156 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6157 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6158 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6159 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6160 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006161 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006162 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006163 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006164
6165 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6166 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6167 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6168 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6169 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6170 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6171
6172 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6173 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6174
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006175 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6176 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006177
6178
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006179stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6180 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006182 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006183
6184 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6185 matched.
6186
6187 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6188 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6189
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006190 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6191 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6192 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6193
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006194 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6195 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6196 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6197 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006198
6199 Example :
6200 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6201 backend stats_localhost
6202 stats enable
6203 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6204
6205 Example :
6206 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6207 backend stats_auth
6208 stats enable
6209 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6210 stats admin if TRUE
6211
6212 Example :
6213 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6214 userlist stats-auth
6215 group admin users admin
6216 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6217 group readonly users haproxy
6218 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6219
6220 backend stats_auth
6221 stats enable
6222 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6223 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6224 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6225 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6226
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006227 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6228 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6229 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006230
6231
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006232stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6233 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006235 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006236 Arguments :
6237 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6238
6239 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6240
6241 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6242 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6243 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6244 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6245 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6246 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6247
6248 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6249 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6250 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006251 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006252
6253 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6254 report using "stats scope".
6255
6256 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6257 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6258 unobvious parameters.
6259
6260 Example :
6261 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6262 backend public_www
6263 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6264 stats enable
6265 stats hide-version
6266 stats scope .
6267 stats uri /admin?stats
6268 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6269 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6270 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6271
6272 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6273 backend private_monitoring
6274 stats enable
6275 stats uri /admin?stats
6276 stats refresh 5s
6277
6278 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6279
6280
6281stats enable
6282 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006285 Arguments : none
6286
6287 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6288 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6289 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6290 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6291 - stats auth : no authentication
6292 - stats scope : no restriction
6293
6294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6296 unobvious parameters.
6297
6298 Example :
6299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6300 backend public_www
6301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6302 stats enable
6303 stats hide-version
6304 stats scope .
6305 stats uri /admin?stats
6306 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6309
6310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6311 backend private_monitoring
6312 stats enable
6313 stats uri /admin?stats
6314 stats refresh 5s
6315
6316 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6317
6318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319stats hide-version
6320 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006322 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006323 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006324
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006325 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6326 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6327 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6328 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6329 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6330 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006332 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6333 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6334 unobvious parameters.
6335
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006336 Example :
6337 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6338 backend public_www
6339 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006340 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006341 stats hide-version
6342 stats scope .
6343 stats uri /admin?stats
6344 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6345 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6346 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006347
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006348 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6349 backend private_monitoring
6350 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006351 stats uri /admin?stats
6352 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006353
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006354 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006355
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006356
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006357stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6358 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6359 Access control for statistics
6360
6361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6362 no | no | yes | yes
6363
6364 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6365 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6366 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6367 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6368 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6369 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6370
6371 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6372 instance.
6373
6374 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6375 about ACL usage.
6376
6377
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006378stats realm <realm>
6379 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006381 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006382 Arguments :
6383 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6384 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6385 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6386
6387 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6388 using a backslash ('\').
6389
6390 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6391 only related to authentication.
6392
6393 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6394 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6395 unobvious parameters.
6396
6397 Example :
6398 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6399 backend public_www
6400 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6401 stats enable
6402 stats hide-version
6403 stats scope .
6404 stats uri /admin?stats
6405 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6406 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6407 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6408
6409 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6410 backend private_monitoring
6411 stats enable
6412 stats uri /admin?stats
6413 stats refresh 5s
6414
6415 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6416
6417
6418stats refresh <delay>
6419 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006421 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006422 Arguments :
6423 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6424 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6425 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6426 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6427 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6428 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6429
6430 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6431 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6432 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6433 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6434
6435 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6436 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6437 unobvious parameters.
6438
6439 Example :
6440 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6441 backend public_www
6442 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6443 stats enable
6444 stats hide-version
6445 stats scope .
6446 stats uri /admin?stats
6447 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6448 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6449 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6450
6451 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6452 backend private_monitoring
6453 stats enable
6454 stats uri /admin?stats
6455 stats refresh 5s
6456
6457 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6458
6459
6460stats scope { <name> | "." }
6461 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006463 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006464 Arguments :
6465 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6466 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6467 section in which the statement appears.
6468
6469 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6470 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6471 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6472 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6473 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6474 exists.
6475
6476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6478 unobvious parameters.
6479
6480 Example :
6481 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6482 backend public_www
6483 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6484 stats enable
6485 stats hide-version
6486 stats scope .
6487 stats uri /admin?stats
6488 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6489 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6490 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6491
6492 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6493 backend private_monitoring
6494 stats enable
6495 stats uri /admin?stats
6496 stats refresh 5s
6497
6498 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6499
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006500
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006501stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006502 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006505
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006506 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006507 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6508
6509 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6510 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6511
6512 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6513 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006514 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006515
6516 Example :
6517 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6518 backend private_monitoring
6519 stats enable
6520 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6521 stats uri /admin?stats
6522 stats refresh 5s
6523
6524 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6525 global section.
6526
6527
6528stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006529 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | yes | yes | yes
6532 Arguments : none
6533
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006534 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006535 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6536 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6537 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6538 - IP (socket, server)
6539 - cookie (backend, server)
6540
6541 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6542 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006543 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006544
6545 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6546
6547
6548stats show-node [ <name> ]
6549 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006551 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006552 Arguments:
6553 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6554 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6555
6556 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6557 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006558 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006559
6560 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6561 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6562 unobvious parameters.
6563
6564 Example:
6565 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6566 backend private_monitoring
6567 stats enable
6568 stats show-node Europe-1
6569 stats uri /admin?stats
6570 stats refresh 5s
6571
6572 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6573 section.
6574
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006575
6576stats uri <prefix>
6577 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006579 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006580 Arguments :
6581 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6582 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6583 query string.
6584
6585 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6586 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6587 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6588 possible to reach it in the application.
6589
6590 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006591 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006592 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6593 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6594 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6595 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6596
6597 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6598 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6599 an address or a port to statistics only.
6600
6601 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6602 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6603 unobvious parameters.
6604
6605 Example :
6606 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6607 backend public_www
6608 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6609 stats enable
6610 stats hide-version
6611 stats scope .
6612 stats uri /admin?stats
6613 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6614 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6615 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6616
6617 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6618 backend private_monitoring
6619 stats enable
6620 stats uri /admin?stats
6621 stats refresh 5s
6622
6623 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6624
6625
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006626stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6627 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006629 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006630
6631 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006632 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006633 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6634 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6635 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6636
6637 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6638 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6639 the "stick-table" statement.
6640
6641 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6642 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6643 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6644 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6645 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6646
6647 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6648 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6649 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6650 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6651 transformation rules.
6652
6653 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6654 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6655 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6656 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6657 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6658 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6659 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6660
6661 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6662 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6663 ACL based conditions.
6664
6665 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6666 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6667 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6668 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6669
6670 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6671 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6672 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6673 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6674
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006675 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6676 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6677 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6678
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006679 Example :
6680 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6681 # last 30 minutes
6682 backend pop
6683 mode tcp
6684 balance roundrobin
6685 stick store-request src
6686 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6687 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6688 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6689
6690 backend smtp
6691 mode tcp
6692 balance roundrobin
6693 stick match src table pop
6694 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6695 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6696
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006697 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006698 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006699
6700
6701stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6702 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6704 no | no | yes | yes
6705
6706 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6707 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6708 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6709 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6710
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006711 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6712 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6713 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6714
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006715 Examples :
6716 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006717 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006718
6719 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6720 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6721 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6722
6723
6724 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6725 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6726 backend http
6727 mode http
6728 balance roundrobin
6729 stick on src table https
6730 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6731 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6732 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6733
6734 backend https
6735 mode tcp
6736 balance roundrobin
6737 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6738 stick on src
6739 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6740 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6741
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006742 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006743
6744
6745stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6746 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 no | no | yes | yes
6749
6750 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006751 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006752 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6753 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6754 server is selected.
6755
6756 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6757 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6758 the "stick-table" statement.
6759
6760 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6761 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6762 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6763 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6764 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6765 address.
6766
6767 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6768 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6769 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6770 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6771 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6772 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6773 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6774 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6775 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6776 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6777
6778 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6779 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6780 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6781 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6782 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6783 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6784 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6785
6786 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6787 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6788 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6789 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6790
6791 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6792 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6793 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6794 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6795 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6796 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006797 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6798 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6799 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6800 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6801 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6802 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006803
6804 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6805 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6806 the request.
6807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006808 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6809 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6810 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6811
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006812 Example :
6813 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6814 # last 30 minutes
6815 backend pop
6816 mode tcp
6817 balance roundrobin
6818 stick store-request src
6819 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6820 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6821 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6822
6823 backend smtp
6824 mode tcp
6825 balance roundrobin
6826 stick match src table pop
6827 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6828 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6829
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006830 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006831 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006832
6833
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006834stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006835 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6836 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006837 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006839 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006840
6841 Arguments :
6842 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6843 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6844 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6845 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6846
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006847 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6848 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6849 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6850 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6851
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006852 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6853 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6854 instance.
6855
6856 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6857 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6858 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6859 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6860 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6861 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006862 to 32 characters.
6863
6864 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6865 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6866 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006867 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006868 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6869 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006870
6871 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006872 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6873 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006874 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6875 increase.
6876
6877 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006878 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6879 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6880 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006881
6882 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6883 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6884 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6885 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6886 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6887 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6888 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6889 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6890 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6891 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6892 parameter (see below).
6893
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006894 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6895 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6896 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6897 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6898 soft restart.
6899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006900 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006902 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6903 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6904 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6905 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6906 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006907 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006908 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6909 if not expiration delay is specified.
6910
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006911 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6912 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6913 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6914 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006915 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6916 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6917 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6918 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6919 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6920 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6921 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6922 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6923 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6924 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6925 types and their arguments.
6926
6927 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6928 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6929 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6930 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6931
6932 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6933 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6934 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6935 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6936
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006937 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6938 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6939 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6940 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6941 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6942 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6943
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006944 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6945 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6946 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6947 they were received.
6948
6949 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6950 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6951 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6952 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6953 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6954
6955 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6956 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6957 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6958 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6959 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6960
6961 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6962 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6963 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6964
6965 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6966 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6967 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6968 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6969 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6970
6971 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6972 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6973 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6974 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6975 the client side.
6976
6977 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6978 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6979 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6980 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6981 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6982 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6983 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6984
6985 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6986 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6987 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6988 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6989 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6990 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6991 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6992
6993 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6994 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6995 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6996 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6997 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6998 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6999
7000 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7001 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7002 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7003 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7004
7005 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7006 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7007 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7008 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7009 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7010 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7011 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7012 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7013 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7014 recommended for better fairness.
7015
7016 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7017 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7018 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7019 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7020
7021 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7022 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7023 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7024 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7025 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7026 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7027 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7028 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7029 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7030 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007031
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007032 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7033 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007034 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7035 reference it.
7036
7037 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7038 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7039 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7040 as an exclusive stickiness.
7041
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007042 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7043 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7044 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7045 something that can be ignored.
7046
7047 Example:
7048 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7049 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7050 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7051 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7052
7053 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007054 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007055
7056
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007057stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7058 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | no | yes | yes
7061
7062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007063 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007064 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7065 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7066 server is selected.
7067
7068 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7069 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7070 the "stick-table" statement.
7071
7072 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7073 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7074 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7075 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7076
7077 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7078 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7079 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7080 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7081 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7082 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007083 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007084 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7085 rules.
7086
7087 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7088 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7089 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7090 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7091 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7092 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7093 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7094
7095 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7096 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7097 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7098 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7099
7100 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7101 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7102 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7103 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7104 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7105 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007106 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7107 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7108 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7109 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7110 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7111 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7112 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7113 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7114 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007115
7116 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7117
7118 Example :
7119 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7120 backend https
7121 mode tcp
7122 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007123 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007124 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007125
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007126 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7127 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7128
7129 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7130 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7131 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7132
7133 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7134 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007135
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007136 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7137 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7138 # at offset 44.
7139
7140 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7141 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7142
7143 # Learn on response if server hello.
7144 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007145
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007146 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7147 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7148
7149 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7150 extraction.
7151
7152
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007153tcp-check connect [params*]
7154 Opens a new connection
7155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 no | no | yes | yes
7157
7158 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7159 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7160 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7161
7162 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7163 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7164 of the sequence.
7165
7166 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7167 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7168 do.
7169
7170 Parameters :
7171 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7172 use the TCP connection.
7173
7174 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7175 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7176 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7177
7178 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7179
7180 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7181
7182 Examples:
7183 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7184 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7185 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7186 option tcp-check
7187 tcp-check connect
7188 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7189 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7190 tcp-check send \r\n
7191 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7192 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7193 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7194 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7195 tcp-check send \r\n
7196 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7197 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7198
7199 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7200 option tcp-check
7201 tcp-check connect port 110
7202 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7203 tcp-check connect port 143
7204 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7205 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7206
7207 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7208
7209
7210tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7211 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7213 no | no | yes | yes
7214
7215 Arguments :
7216 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7217 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7218 binary.
7219 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7220 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7221 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7222
7223 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7224 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7225 with the usual backslash ('\').
7226 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7227 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7228 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7229 used upper or lower case.
7230
7231
7232 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7233
7234 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7235 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7236 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7237 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7238 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7239 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7240 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7241 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7242
7243 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7244 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7245 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7246 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7247 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7248 expression.
7249
7250 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7251 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7252 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7253 this exact hexadecimal string.
7254 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7255
7256 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7257 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7258 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7259 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7260 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7261 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7262 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7263 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7264 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7265 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7266 the null character.
7267
7268 Examples :
7269 # perform a POP check
7270 option tcp-check
7271 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7272
7273 # perform an IMAP check
7274 option tcp-check
7275 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7276
7277 # look for the redis master server
7278 option tcp-check
7279 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7280 tcp-check expect +PONG
7281 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7282 tcp-check expect string role:master
7283 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7284 tcp-check expect string +OK
7285
7286
7287 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7288 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7289
7290
7291tcp-check send <data>
7292 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 no | no | yes | yes
7295
7296 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7297 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7298
7299 Examples :
7300 # look for the redis master server
7301 option tcp-check
7302 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7303 tcp-check expect string role:master
7304
7305 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7306 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7307
7308
7309tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7310 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7311 tcp health check
7312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 no | no | yes | yes
7314
7315 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7316 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7317 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7318 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7319 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7320 hexadecimal string.
7321 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7322
7323 Examples :
7324 # redis check in binary
7325 option tcp-check
7326 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7327 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7328
7329
7330 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7331 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7332
7333
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007334tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7335 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7337 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007338 Arguments :
7339 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007340 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7341 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007343 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007344
7345 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7346 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007347 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7348 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7349 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7350 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7351 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7352 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007353
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007354 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7355 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7356 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7357 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007358
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007359 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007360 - accept :
7361 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7362 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7363 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007364
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 - reject :
7366 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7367 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7368 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7369 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7370 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7371 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7372 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7373 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7374 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7375 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7376 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7377 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007378
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007379 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7380 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7381 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7382 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7383 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7384 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7385 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7386 hosts.
7387
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007388 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7389 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7390 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7391 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7392 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7393 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7394 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7395 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7396 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7397 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7398 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7399
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007400 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007401 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7402 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7403 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007404 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7405 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007407 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7408 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7409 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7410 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7411 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007412
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007413 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007414 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007415 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007416 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7417 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7418 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7419 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007421 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7422 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7423 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7424 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7427 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7428 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7429 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7430 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007431 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7432 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7433 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7434 layer7 information is extracted.
7435
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007436 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7437 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7438 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7439 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7440 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7443 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7444 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007445
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007446 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7447 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7448 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007450 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007451 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007452 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007453
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007454 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7455 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7456 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007458 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007459 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7460 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007461
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007462 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7463
7464 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7465
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007466 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7467
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007468 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007469
7470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7472 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007474 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007475 Arguments :
7476 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007477 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007478 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7479 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007480
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007483 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7484 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7485 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7486 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7487 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007489 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7490 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7491 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7492 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007493 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7494 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7495 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7496 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7497 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7498 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007499 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007500 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007502 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7503 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7504 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7505 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007506
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007507 Four types of actions are supported :
7508 - accept : the request is accepted
7509 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7510 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007511 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007513 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7514 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007515
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007516 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7517 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7518 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7519 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7520 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7521 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007523 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007524 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7525 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007526
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007527 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007528 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7529 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7530 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7531 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007532 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7533 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7534 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007536 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7537 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7538 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7539 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7540
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007541 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007542 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7543 # and reject everything else.
7544 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7545 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007546 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 tcp-request content reject
7548
7549 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007550 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7551 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7552 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007553 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007554
7555 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7556 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7557 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007558 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007559 tcp-request content reject
7560
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007561 Example:
7562 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7563 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007564 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007565
7566 Example:
7567 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7568 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007569 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007570
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007571 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7572 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7573
7574 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007575 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007576 # protecting all our sites
7577 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007578 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7579 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007580 ...
7581 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7582
7583 backend http_dynamic
7584 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007585 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007586 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007587 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7588 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7589 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007590 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007592 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007594 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007595
7596
7597tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7598 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007600 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601 Arguments :
7602 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7603 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7604 as explained at the top of this document.
7605
7606 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7607 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7608 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7609 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7610 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7611
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007612 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7613 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7614 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7615 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7616
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007617 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7618 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007619 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007620 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007621 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7622 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7623 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7624 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007625
7626 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7627 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7628 it pass through unaffected.
7629
7630 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7631 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7632 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007633 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007634 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7635 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007636 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7637 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7638 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007639
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007640 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007641 "timeout client".
7642
7643
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007644tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7645 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7647 no | no | yes | yes
7648 Arguments :
7649 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007650 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007651
7652 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7653
7654 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7655 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7656 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007657 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7658 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007659
7660 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7661
7662 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7663 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7664 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7665 inserted.
7666
7667 Two types of actions are supported :
7668 - accept :
7669 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7670 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7671 the rules evaluation.
7672
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007673 - close :
7674 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7675 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7676 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7677 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7678 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7679 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007680 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007681 protocols.
7682
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007683 - reject :
7684 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7685 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007686 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007687
7688 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7689 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7690 for changing the default action to a reject.
7691
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007692 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7693 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7694 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7695 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007696 period.
7697
7698 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7699
7700 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7701
7702
7703tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7704 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7706 no | no | yes | yes
7707 Arguments :
7708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7710 as explained at the top of this document.
7711
7712 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7713
7714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007715timeout check <timeout>
7716 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7717 established.
7718
7719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 yes | no | yes | yes
7721 Arguments:
7722 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7723 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7724 as explained at the top of this document.
7725
7726 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7727 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7728 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7729 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007730 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7731 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7732 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007733
7734 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7735 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7736
7737 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7738 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007739 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007740
7741 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7742 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7743 forget about it.
7744
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007745 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7746 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007747
7748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007749timeout client <timeout>
7750timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7751 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7753 yes | yes | yes | no
7754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007755 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007756 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7757 as explained at the top of this document.
7758
7759 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7760 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7761 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7762 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7763 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7764 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7765 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7766 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007767 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007768 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007769 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7770 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007771 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7772 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007773
7774 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7776 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7777 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7778 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7779 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7780
7781 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7782 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7783 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7784
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007785 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007786
7787
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007788timeout client-fin <timeout>
7789 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7791 yes | yes | yes | no
7792 Arguments :
7793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7795 as explained at the top of this document.
7796
7797 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7798 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7799 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7800 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7801 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7802 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7803 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7804 down in one direction.
7805
7806 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7807 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7808 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7809
7810 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7811
7812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007813timeout connect <timeout>
7814timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7815 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 yes | no | yes | yes
7818 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007819 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007820 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7821 as explained at the top of this document.
7822
7823 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007824 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007825 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007826 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007827 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7828 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007829
7830 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7831 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7832 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7833 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7834 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7835 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7836
7837 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7838 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7839 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7840
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007841 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7842 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007843
7844
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007845timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7846 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | yes | yes | yes
7849 Arguments :
7850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7852 as explained at the top of this document.
7853
7854 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7855 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7856 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7857 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7858 once the request has started to present itself.
7859
7860 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7861 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7862 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7863 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7864 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7865
7866 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7867 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7868 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7869 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7870
7871 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7872 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7873 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7874 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7875 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007876 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007877
7878 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7879 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7880 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7881 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7882
7883 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7884
7885
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007886timeout http-request <timeout>
7887 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007889 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007890 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007891 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007892 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7893 as explained at the top of this document.
7894
7895 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7896 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7897 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7898 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7899 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7900 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7901 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007902 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7903 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7904 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7905 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7906 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7907 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7908 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007909
7910 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7911 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007912 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7913 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007914
7915 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7916 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7917 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7918 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7919 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7920
7921 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007922 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7923 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7924 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007925
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007926 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007927
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007928
7929timeout queue <timeout>
7930 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 yes | no | yes | yes
7933 Arguments :
7934 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7936 as explained at the top of this document.
7937
7938 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7939 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7940 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7941 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7942 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7943
7944 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7945 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7946 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7947 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7948
7949 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7950
7951
7952timeout server <timeout>
7953timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7954 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | no | yes | yes
7957 Arguments :
7958 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7960 as explained at the top of this document.
7961
7962 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7963 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7964 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7965 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7966 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7967 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7968 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7969
7970 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7971 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7972 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7973 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7974 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007975 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007976 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007977 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7978 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7979 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7980 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007981
7982 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7983 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7984 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7985 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7986 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7987 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7988
7989 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7990 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7991 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7992
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007993 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007994
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007995
7996timeout server-fin <timeout>
7997 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | no | yes | yes
8000 Arguments :
8001 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8002 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8003 as explained at the top of this document.
8004
8005 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8006 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8007 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8008 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8009 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8010 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8011 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8012 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8013 situations, it should not be needed.
8014
8015 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8016 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8017 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8018
8019 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008021
8022timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008023 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8025 yes | yes | yes | yes
8026 Arguments :
8027 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8029 as explained at the top of this document.
8030
8031 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8032 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8033 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8034
8035 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8036 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8037 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8038 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008039 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008040
8041 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8042
8043
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008044timeout tunnel <timeout>
8045 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8047 yes | no | yes | yes
8048 Arguments :
8049 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8050 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8051 as explained at the top of this document.
8052
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008053 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008054 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8055 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8056 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8057 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8058 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8059 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8060 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8061 specified.
8062
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008063 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8064 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8065 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8066 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8067 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8068 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8069 state.
8070
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008071 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8072 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8073 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8074 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8075 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8076
8077 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8078 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8079 forget about it.
8080
8081 Example :
8082 defaults http
8083 option http-server-close
8084 timeout connect 5s
8085 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008086 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008087 timeout server 30s
8088 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8089
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008090 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008091
8092
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008093transparent (deprecated)
8094 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008096 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008097 Arguments : none
8098
8099 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8100 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8101 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8102 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8103 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8104 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8105 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8106 appropriate server.
8107
8108 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8109
8110 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8111 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8112
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008113 See also: "option transparent"
8114
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008115unique-id-format <string>
8116 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 yes | yes | yes | no
8119 Arguments :
8120 <string> is a log-format string.
8121
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008122 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8123 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8124 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8125 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008127 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8128 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8129 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8130 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8131 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8132 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8133 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8134 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008136 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8137 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008138
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008139 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008140
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008141 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008142
8143 will generate:
8144
8145 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8146
8147 See also: "unique-id-header"
8148
8149unique-id-header <name>
8150 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | yes | yes | no
8153 Arguments :
8154 <name> is the name of the header.
8155
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008156 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8157 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008158
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008159 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008160
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008161 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008162 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8163
8164 will generate:
8165
8166 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8167
8168 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008169
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008170use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008171 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8173 no | yes | yes | no
8174 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008175 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8176 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008177
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008178 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8179 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008180
8181 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8182 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8183 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008184 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8185 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8186 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8187 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008188
8189 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8190 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8191 assign the backend.
8192
8193 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8194 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8195 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8196 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8197 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8198 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8199
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008200 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008201 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008202 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8203 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8204 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8205
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008206 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8207 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8208 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8209 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8210 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8211 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8212 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8213 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8214 cannot be forced from the request.
8215
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008216 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008217 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8218 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8219
8220 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8221 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008222
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008223
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008224use-server <server> if <condition>
8225use-server <server> unless <condition>
8226 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8228 no | no | yes | yes
8229 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008230 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008231
8232 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8233
8234 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8235 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8236 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8237
8238 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8239 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8240 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8241 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8242 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8243 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8244 matches will assign the server.
8245
8246 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8247 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8248 with the next rules until one matches.
8249
8250 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8251 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8252 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8253 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8254
8255 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8256 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8257 stripped.
8258
8259 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8260 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8261 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8262 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8263
8264 Example :
8265 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8266 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8267 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8268 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8269 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8270 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8271 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8272 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8273 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8274
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008275 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008276
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008277
82785. Bind and Server options
8279--------------------------
8280
8281The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8282depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8283settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8284written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8285described in this section.
8286
8287
82885.1. Bind options
8289-----------------
8290
8291The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8292as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8293no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8294parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8295while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8296provided immediately after the setting name.
8297
8298The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8299
8300accept-proxy
8301 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008302 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8303 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008304 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8305 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8306 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8307 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8308 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8309 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8310 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008311 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8312 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008313
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008314alpn <protocols>
8315 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8316 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8317 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8318 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8319 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8320 initial NPN extension.
8321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322backlog <backlog>
8323 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8324 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8325
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008326ecdhe <named curve>
8327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008328 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8329 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008330
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008331ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8333 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8334 client's certificate.
8335
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008336ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8338 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8339 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8340 error is ignored.
8341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008342ciphers <ciphers>
8343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8344 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008345 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008346 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8347 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8348
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008349crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8351 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8352 to verify client's certificate.
8353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008354crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8356 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8357 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8358 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8359 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8360 file.
8361
8362 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8363 are loaded.
8364
8365 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008366 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8367 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008368 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8369 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8370 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8371 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8372 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8373 www.sub.example.org).
8374
8375 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8376 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8377 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8378 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8379 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8380
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008381 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008382
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008383 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8384 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008385 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008386 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8387 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8388 clients).
8389
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008390 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8391 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8392 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8393 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8394 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8395 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8396 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8397 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8398 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8399 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8400 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8401 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8402 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8403
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008404crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8406 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008407 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008408 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008409
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008410crt-list <file>
8411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008412 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8413 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008414
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008415 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008416
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008417 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8418 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8419 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8420 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8421 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8422 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8423 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8424 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008425
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008426defer-accept
8427 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8428 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8429 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8430 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8431 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8432 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8433 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8434 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8435 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8436 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8437 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8438
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008439force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008440 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008441 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8442 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8443
8444force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008445 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008446 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8447
8448force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008449 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008450 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8451
8452force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008453 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008454 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8455
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008456gid <gid>
8457 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8458 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8459 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8460 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8461 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8462
8463group <group>
8464 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8465 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8466 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8467 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8468 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8469
8470id <id>
8471 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8472 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8473 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8474 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8475
8476interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008477 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8478 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8479 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8480 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8481 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8482 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8483 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008484
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008485level <level>
8486 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8487 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8488 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8489 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8490 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8491 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8492 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8493 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8494 counters).
8495 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8496 all counters).
8497
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008498maxconn <maxconn>
8499 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8500 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8501 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8502 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8503 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8504 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8505 eat all memory.
8506
8507mode <mode>
8508 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8509 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8510 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8511 UNIX sockets.
8512
8513mss <maxseg>
8514 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8515 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8516 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8517 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8518 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8519 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8520 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8521 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8522 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8523 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8524 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8525
8526name <name>
8527 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8528 page.
8529
8530nice <nice>
8531 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8532 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8533 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8534 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8535 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8536 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8537 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8538 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8539 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8540 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8541 one for an RDP socket.
8542
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008543no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008545 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008546 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008547 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8548 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008549
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008550no-tls-tickets
8551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8552 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8553 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8554 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8555
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008556no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008558 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008559 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8560 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8561 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008562
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008563no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008565 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008566 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8567 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8568 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008570no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008572 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008573 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8574 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8575 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008576
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008577npn <protocols>
8578 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8579 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8580 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8581 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008582 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8583 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008584
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008585process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8586 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8587 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8588 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8589 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8590 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8591 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8592 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008593 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8594 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8595 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8596 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8597 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8598 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8599 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008601ssl
8602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008603 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008604 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8605 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8606 to deciphered contents.
8607
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008608strict-sni
8609 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8610 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8611 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8612 See the "crt" option for more information.
8613
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008614tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008615 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008616 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8617 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8618 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8619 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8620 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8621 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8622 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008623 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8624 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8625 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008627transparent
8628 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8629 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8630 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8631 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8632 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8633 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8634 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8635 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8636 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8637 so check for support with your vendor.
8638
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008639v4v6
8640 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8641 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8642 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8643 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008644 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008645
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008646v6only
8647 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8648 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8649 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008650 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8651 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008652
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008653uid <uid>
8654 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8655 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8656 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8657 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8658 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8659
8660user <user>
8661 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8662 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8663 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8664 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8665 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8666
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008667verify [none|optional|required]
8668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8669 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8670 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8671 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8672 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008673 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8674 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8675 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8676 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086785.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008679------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008681The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8682which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8683arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8684settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8685after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8686Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8687address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008689 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008690 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008692The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008693
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008694addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008695 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8696 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8697 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8698 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8699 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008701 Supported in default-server: No
8702
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008703agent-check
8704 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008705 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8706 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8707 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8708 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008709
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008710 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008711 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8712 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8713
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008714 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8715 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008716
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008717 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8718 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8719 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008720
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008721 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8722 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8723 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008724
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008725 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8726 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8727 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8728 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8729 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8730 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8731 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008733 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8734 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008735
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008736 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8737 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8738 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8739 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8740 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8741 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8742 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8743 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8744 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008745
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008746 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8747 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008748 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8749 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8750 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8751 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008752
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008753 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8754 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008755
8756 Supported in default-server: No
8757
8758agent-inter <delay>
8759 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8760 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8761
8762 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8763 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8764 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8765 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8766 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8767 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8768 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8769 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8770 of backends use the same servers.
8771
8772 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8773
8774 Supported in default-server: Yes
8775
8776agent-port <port>
8777 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8778
8779 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8780
8781 Supported in default-server: Yes
8782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008783backup
8784 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8785 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8786 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8787 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8788 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8789 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008791 Supported in default-server: No
8792
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008793ca-file <cafile>
8794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8795 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8796 server's certificate.
8797
8798 Supported in default-server: No
8799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008800check
8801 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008802 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8803 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8804 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8805 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8806 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8807 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8808 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008809 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8810 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8811 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008813 Supported in default-server: No
8814
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008815check-send-proxy
8816 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8817 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8818 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8819 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8820 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8821 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8822 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8823
8824 Supported in default-server: No
8825
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008826check-ssl
8827 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8828 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8829 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8830 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008831 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008832 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8833 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8834 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8835 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8836
8837 Supported in default-server: No
8838
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008839ciphers <ciphers>
8840 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008841 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008842 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8843 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8844 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8845 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8846 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8847 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8848
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008849 Supported in default-server: No
8850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008851cookie <value>
8852 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8853 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8854 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8855 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8856 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8857 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8858 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008860 Supported in default-server: No
8861
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008862crl-file <crlfile>
8863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8864 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8865 to verify server's certificate.
8866
8867 Supported in default-server: No
8868
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008869crt <cert>
8870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8871 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8872 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8873 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8874 certificate request.
8875
8876 Supported in default-server: No
8877
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008878disabled
8879 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8880 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8881 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8882 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8883 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8884
8885 Supported in default-server: No
8886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008887error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008888 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8889 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8890 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008892 Supported in default-server: Yes
8893
8894 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008896fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008897 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8898 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8899 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008901 Supported in default-server: Yes
8902
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008903force-sslv3
8904 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8905 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8906 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8907
8908 Supported in default-server: No
8909
8910force-tlsv10
8911 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8912 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8913
8914 Supported in default-server: No
8915
8916force-tlsv11
8917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8918 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8919
8920 Supported in default-server: No
8921
8922force-tlsv12
8923 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8924 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8925
8926 Supported in default-server: No
8927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008928id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008929 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8930 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8931 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008933 Supported in default-server: No
8934
8935inter <delay>
8936fastinter <delay>
8937downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008938 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8939 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8940 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8941 between checks depending on the server state :
8942
8943 Server state | Interval used
8944 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8945 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8946 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8947 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8948 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8949 or yet unchecked. |
8950 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8951 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8952 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008954 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8955 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8956 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8957 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008958 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8959 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8960 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8961 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8962 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008964 Supported in default-server: Yes
8965
8966maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008967 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8968 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8969 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8970 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8971 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8972 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8973 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8974 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008976 Supported in default-server: Yes
8977
8978maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008979 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8980 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8981 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8982 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8983 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8984 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8985 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008987 Supported in default-server: Yes
8988
8989minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008990 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8991 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8992 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8993 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8994 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8995 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008996 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008999 Supported in default-server: Yes
9000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009001no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009002 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009004 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009005
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009006 Supported in default-server: No
9007
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009008no-tls-tickets
9009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9010 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9011 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
9012 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
9013
9014 Supported in default-server: No
9015
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009016no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009017 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009018 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9019 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009020 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9021 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009022
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009023 Supported in default-server: No
9024
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009025no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009026 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009027 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9028 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009029 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9030 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009031
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009032 Supported in default-server: No
9033
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009034no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009035 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009036 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9037 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009038 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9039 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009040
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009041 Supported in default-server: No
9042
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009043non-stick
9044 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9045 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9046 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9047
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009048 Supported in default-server: No
9049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009050observe <mode>
9051 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9052 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9053 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9054 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9055 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9056 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009057 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009059 Supported in default-server: No
9060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009061 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009063on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009064 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9065 Currently, four modes are available:
9066 - fastinter: force fastinter
9067 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9068 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9069 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9070 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009072 Supported in default-server: Yes
9073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009074 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9075
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009076on-marked-down <action>
9077 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9078 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009079 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9080 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9081 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9082 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9083 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9084 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9085 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9086 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009087
9088 Actions are disabled by default
9089
9090 Supported in default-server: Yes
9091
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009092on-marked-up <action>
9093 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9094 Currently one action is available:
9095 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9096 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9097 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9098 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9099 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9100 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9101 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9102 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9103
9104 Actions are disabled by default
9105
9106 Supported in default-server: Yes
9107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009108port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009109 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9110 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9111 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9112 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9113 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9114 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009116 Supported in default-server: Yes
9117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009118redir <prefix>
9119 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9120 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9121 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9122 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9123 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9124 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9125 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9126 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009127 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009128 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9129 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9130 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9131 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9132 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9133
9134 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009136 Supported in default-server: No
9137
9138rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009139 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9140 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9141 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009143 Supported in default-server: Yes
9144
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009145send-proxy
9146 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9147 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9148 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9149 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9150 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9151 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9152 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9153 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9154 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009155 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9156 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9157 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9158 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9159 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009160
9161 Supported in default-server: No
9162
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009163send-proxy-v2
9164 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9165 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9166 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9167 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9168 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9169 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9170 option of the "bind" keyword.
9171
9172 Supported in default-server: No
9173
9174send-proxy-v2-ssl
9175 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9176 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9177 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9178 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9179 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9180 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9181 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9182 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9183
9184 Supported in default-server: No
9185
9186send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9187 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9188 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9189 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9190 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9191 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9192 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9193 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9194 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9195 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9196
9197 Supported in default-server: No
9198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009199slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009200 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9201 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9202 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9203 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9204 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9205 parameters :
9206
9207 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9208 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9209
9210 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9211 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9212 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9213 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9214
9215 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9216 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9217 seen as failed.
9218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009219 Supported in default-server: Yes
9220
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009221source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009222source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009223source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009224 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9225 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9226 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9227 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9228
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009229 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9230 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9231 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9232 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9233 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9234 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9235 server.
9236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009237 Supported in default-server: No
9238
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009239ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009240 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9241 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9242 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9243 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9244 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9245 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009246 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009247
9248 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009250track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009251 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9252 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9253 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9254 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009255 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009257 Supported in default-server: No
9258
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009259verify [none|required]
9260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009261 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9262 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9263 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9264 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009265 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9266 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9267 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009268
9269 Supported in default-server: No
9270
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009271verifyhost <hostname>
9272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9273 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9274 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9275 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9276 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9277 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9278
9279 Supported in default-server: No
9280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009281weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009282 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9283 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9284 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009285 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9286 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9287 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9288 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9289 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9290 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009292 Supported in default-server: Yes
9293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294
92956. HTTP header manipulation
9296---------------------------
9297
9298In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9299response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9300request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9301which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009302against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009303
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009304If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9305to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9306but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9307HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9308stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9309because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9310a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9311still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009313This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9314in section 4.2 :
9315
9316 - reqadd <string>
9317 - reqallow <search>
9318 - reqiallow <search>
9319 - reqdel <search>
9320 - reqidel <search>
9321 - reqdeny <search>
9322 - reqideny <search>
9323 - reqpass <search>
9324 - reqipass <search>
9325 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9326 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9327 - reqtarpit <search>
9328 - reqitarpit <search>
9329 - rspadd <string>
9330 - rspdel <search>
9331 - rspidel <search>
9332 - rspdeny <search>
9333 - rspideny <search>
9334 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9335 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9336
9337With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9338is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9339parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9340prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9341Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9342
9343 \t for a tab
9344 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9345 \n for a new line (LF)
9346 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9347 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9348 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9349 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9350 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9351
9352The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9353portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9354above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9355regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9357is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9358
9359The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9360after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9361
9362Notes related to these keywords :
9363---------------------------------
9364 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9365 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9366 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9367
9368 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9369 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9370 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9371
9372 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9373 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9374 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9375 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9376 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9377
9378 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9379 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9380 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9381 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9382 useless headers before adding new ones.
9383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009384 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009385 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9386
9387 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9388 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9389 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9390
9391 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9392 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009393 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009394
9395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9397----------------------------------
9398
9399Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9400client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9401The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9402these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9403but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9404data called patterns.
9405
9406
94077.1. ACL basics
9408---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009409
9410The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9411content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9412from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9413simple :
9414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009415 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009416 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009417 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9418 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009420The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9421adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009422
9423In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009426
9427This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9428Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9429and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009430an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9431conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9432as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9433are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009434
9435ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9436'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9437which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9438
9439There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9440performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9443specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9444this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009445methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9446ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009447
9448Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9449 - boolean
9450 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9451 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9452 - string
9453 - data block
9454
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009455Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9456converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9457would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9458The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9459which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9460
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009461Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9462keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9463fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9464which are summarized in the table below :
9465
9466 +---------------------+-----------------+
9467 | Sample or converter | Default |
9468 | output type | matching method |
9469 +---------------------+-----------------+
9470 | boolean | bool |
9471 +---------------------+-----------------+
9472 | integer | int |
9473 +---------------------+-----------------+
9474 | ip | ip |
9475 +---------------------+-----------------+
9476 | string | str |
9477 +---------------------+-----------------+
9478 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9479 +---------------------+-----------------+
9480
9481Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9482matching method, see below.
9483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009484The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9485 - boolean
9486 - integer or integer range
9487 - IP address / network
9488 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9489 - regular expression
9490 - hex block
9491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009492The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9493
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009494 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9495 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009496 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009497 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009498 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009499 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009500 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009502The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9503read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9504if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9505lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9506will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9507beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9508a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9509lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9510exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9511
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009512The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9513parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9514ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9515a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9516check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9517
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009518The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9519socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9520file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009522Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9523loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9524
9525 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9526
9527In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9528the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9529case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9530as well.
9531
9532The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9533sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9534do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9535methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9536is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9537obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9538followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9539default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9540that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9541string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9542
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009543The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9544By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9545string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9546resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9547server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9548waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9549flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9550function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009552There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9553sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9554be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009555
9556 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9557 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9559 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9560 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9561 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009562
9563 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9564 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009566
9567 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009569
9570 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009572
9573 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9574 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9575
9576 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9577 binary or string samples.
9578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009579 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9580 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9583 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9584 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9587 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009589 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9590 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9593 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009595 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9596 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009597 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009599 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9600 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9601 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009602
9603For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9604request, it is possible to do :
9605
9606 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9607
9608In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9609buffer, one would use the following acl :
9610
9611 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9612
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009613On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9614possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9615
9616 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9619criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9620method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9621to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9622criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9623the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009626the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9627For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9630 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9631 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9632 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009633
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009634
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009635The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9636types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9637combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9638brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9639default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 +-------------------------------------------------+
9642 | Input sample type |
9643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009644 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9646 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009648 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009650 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009652 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009654 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009656 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009658 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009660 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009662 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009663 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009664 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009665 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009666 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009667 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009668 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9670 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9671 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009672
9673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096747.1.1. Matching booleans
9675------------------------
9676
9677In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9678Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9679When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9680that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9681
9682Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9683return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9684"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096877.1.2. Matching integers
9688------------------------
9689
9690Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9691enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9692to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9693
9694Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9695matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9696lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009697
9698For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9699unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9700representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9701
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009702As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9703two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9704instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9705ranges and operators.
9706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009707For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009708operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9709Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9710of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009712Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009713
9714 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9715 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9716 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9717 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9718 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009720For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009721
9722 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9723
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009724This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9725
9726 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097297.1.3. Matching strings
9730-----------------------
9731
9732String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9733different forms :
9734
9735 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9736 patterns ;
9737
9738 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9739 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9740
9741 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9742 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9743
9744 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9745 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9746
9747 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9748 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9749 matches.
9750
9751 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9752 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9753 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009754
9755String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9756exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9757characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9758string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9759to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009760before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009761
9762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097637.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9764---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009765
9766Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9767they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9768possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9769passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9770the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009771the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9772match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009773
9774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9776-------------------------------------
9777
9778It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9779not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9780a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9781to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9782digits may be used upper or lower case.
9783
9784Example :
9785 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9786 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9787
9788
97897.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9790---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009791
9792IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9793netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9794within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009795host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009796difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9797at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9798does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9799parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009800
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009801IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9802Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9803trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9804IPv6 patterns.
9805
9806HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9807following situations :
9808 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9809 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9810 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9811 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9812 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9813 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9814 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9815 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9816 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9817 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009819
98207.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9821----------------------------------
9822
9823Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9824combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9825
9826 - AND (implicit)
9827 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9828 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009830A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009832 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009834Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9835indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009837For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9838"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9839requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9840is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9841
9842 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9843 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9844 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9845 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9846
9847To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9848and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9849
9850 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9851 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9852 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9853 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9854
9855 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9856 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9857 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9858 use_backend www if host_www
9859
9860It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9861expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9862be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9863the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9864
9865 The following rule :
9866
9867 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9868 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9869
9870 Can also be written that way :
9871
9872 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9873
9874It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9875to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9876simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9877sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9878good use is the following :
9879
9880 With named ACLs :
9881
9882 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9883 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9884 monitor fail if site_dead
9885
9886 With anonymous ACLs :
9887
9888 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9889
9890See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9891
9892
98937.3. Fetching samples
9894---------------------
9895
9896Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9897against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9898sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9899ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9900of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9901available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9902
9903This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9904Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9905compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9906deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9907
9908The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9909matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9910method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9911indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9912
9913As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9914when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9915mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9916the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9917ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9918
9919Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9920multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9921when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9922incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9923are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9924is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9925all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9926
9927Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9928 - name
9929 - name(arg1)
9930 - name(arg1,arg2)
9931
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009932
99337.3.1. Converters
9934-----------------
9935
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009936Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9937of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9938is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9939was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9940has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9941unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9942
9943These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9944sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9945the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9946support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009948The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009949
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009950base64
9951 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9952 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9953 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9954
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009955lower
9956 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9957 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9958 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009959
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009960upper
9961 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9962 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9963 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009964
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009965hex
9966 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9967 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9968 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9969 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009971ipmask(<mask>)
9972 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9973 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9974 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9975 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009977http_date([<offset>])
9978 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9979 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9980 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9981 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9982 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9983 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009984
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009985language(<value>[,<default>])
9986 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9987 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9988 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9989 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9990 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9991 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9992 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9993 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9994 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9995 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9996 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9997 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009999 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010001 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10002 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010004 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10005 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10006 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10007 use_backend spanish if es
10008 use_backend french if fr
10009 use_backend english if en
10010 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010011
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010012map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10013map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10014map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10015 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10016 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10017 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10018 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10019 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10020 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10021 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10022 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010023
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010024 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10025 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10026 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010028 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10029 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010031 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10032 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10033 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10034 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010035 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10036 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010037 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10038 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10039 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10040 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10041 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10042 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10043 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10044 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10045 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10046 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10047 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10048 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10049 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10050 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010052 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10053 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10054 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10055 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10056 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010058 Example :
10059
10060 # this is a comment and is ignored
10061 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10062 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10063 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10064 | | | `---------- value
10065 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10066 | `---------------------------- key
10067 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10068
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010069
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100707.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010071--------------------------------------------
10072
10073A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10074not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10075"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10076The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10077
10078always_false : boolean
10079 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10080 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10081
10082always_true : boolean
10083 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10084 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10085
10086avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010087 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010088 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10089 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10090 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10091 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10092 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10093 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10094 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10095 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10096 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10097 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10098 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10099 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10100 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010103 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10104 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10105 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10106 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10107 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010109be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10111 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10112 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10113 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10114 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10115 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010116
10117 Example :
10118 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10119 backend dynamic
10120 mode http
10121 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10122 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10125 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010126 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010127 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10128 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010129
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010130 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010131 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010132 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10133
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010134 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10135 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010136
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010137 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010138 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010139 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010140 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10141 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010142 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010143 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010145 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10146 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010147 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010148 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010149
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010150date([<offset>]) : integer
10151 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10152 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10153 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10154 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010155 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10156
10157 Example :
10158
10159 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10160 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010161
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010162env(<name>) : string
10163 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10164 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10165 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10166 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10167 certain way.
10168
10169 Examples :
10170 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10171 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10172
10173 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10174 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10177 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010178 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10179 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10181 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10182 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10183 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10184 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10188 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10189 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10190 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10191 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10192 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10193 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10194 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010195
10196 Example :
10197 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10198 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10199 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10200 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10201 frontend mail
10202 bind :25
10203 mode tcp
10204 maxconn 100
10205 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10206 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10207 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10208 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010210nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10211 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10212 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10213 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010214 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10215 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10216 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010219 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10220 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10221 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010222 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10223 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10224 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10225 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10226 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10227
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010228rand([<range>]) : integer
10229 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10230 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10231 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10232 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10233 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010235srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10236 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10237 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10238 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10239 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10240 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10241 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10242 methods.
10243
10244srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10245 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10246 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10247 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10248 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10249 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10250 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10251 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10252
10253srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10254 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10255 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010256 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010257 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10258 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10259 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10260 overloading servers).
10261
10262 Example :
10263 # Redirect to a separate back
10264 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10265 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10266 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10267
10268table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10269 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10270 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10271
10272table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10273 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10274 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10275 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10276
10277
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102787.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279----------------------------------
10280
10281The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10282closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10283methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10284sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10285TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010286the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10287counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10288"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010289argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10290the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10291this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010292
10293be_id : integer
10294 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10295 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10296
10297dst : ip
10298 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10299 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10300 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10301 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10302 RFC 4291.
10303
10304dst_conn : integer
10305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10306 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10307 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10308 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10309 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10310 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10311 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10312 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010314dst_port : integer
10315 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10316 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10317 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10318 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10319 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10320 an HTTP header.
10321
10322fe_id : integer
10323 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10324 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10325 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10326
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010327sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010328sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10329sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10330sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010331 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10332 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10333 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10334
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010335sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010336sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10337sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10338sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010339 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10340 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10341 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010343sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010344sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10345sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10346sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010347 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10348 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010349 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10350 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10351 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010352
10353 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10354 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010355 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10356 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10357 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010358 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10359 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010361sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010362sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10363sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10364sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010365 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10366 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010368sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010369sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10370sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10371sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010372 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10373 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10374 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010376sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010377sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10378sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10379sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10381 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10382 See also src_conn_rate.
10383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010384sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010385sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10386sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10387sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010388 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010389 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010390
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010391sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010392sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10393sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10394sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010395 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10396 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10397 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010398 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10399 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10400 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010402sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010403sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10404sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10405sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010406 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10407 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10408 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010410sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010411sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10412sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10413sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010414 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10415 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10416 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10417 src_http_err_rate.
10418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010419sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010420sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10421sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10422sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010423 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10424 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10425 src_http_req_cnt.
10426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010427sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010428sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10429sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10430sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010431 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10432 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10433 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10434 src_http_req_rate.
10435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010436sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010437sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10438sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10439sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010440 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010441 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10442 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10443 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10444 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010445
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010446 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10447 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010448 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10449
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010450sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010451sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10452sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10453sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010454 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10455 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10456 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10457 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010459sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010460sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10461sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10462sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010463 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10464 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10465 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10466 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10467
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010468sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010469sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10470sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10471sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010472 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10473 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10474 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10475 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010476 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010477 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010479sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010480sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10481sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10482sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010483 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10484 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10485 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10486 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10487 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010488 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010490sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010491sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10492sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10493sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010494 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10495 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10496 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10497
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010498sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010499sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10500sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10501sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010502 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10503 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010504 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010505 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10506 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010507 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10508 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10509 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010511so_id : integer
10512 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10513 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10514 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010516src : ip
10517 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10518 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10519 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10520 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10521 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10522 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10523 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010524
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010525 Example:
10526 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10527 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10530 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10531 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10532 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010533 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10536 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10537 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010538 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010539 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10542 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10543 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10544 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10545 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10546 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10547 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010548
10549 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10550 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10551 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10552 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010553 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010554 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10555 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010558 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010560 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010561 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010564 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10566 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010567 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10570 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10571 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10572 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010573 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010575src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010576 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010578 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010579 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010582 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10585 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010586 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10587 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10588 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10591 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10592 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010593 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010594 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010595 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10598 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10599 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10600 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10601 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010602 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10605 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10606 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10607 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010608 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10611 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10612 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10613 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010614 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010615 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10618 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10619 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10620 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010621 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10623 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010624
10625 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010626 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010627 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10630 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10631 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10632 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10633 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010634 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10635 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10638 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10639 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010640 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10641 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010642 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644src_port : integer
10645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10646 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10647 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10648 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10651 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010652 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10653 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10654 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010655 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010657src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10658 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10659 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10660 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10661 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010662 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010664src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10665 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10666 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10667 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10668 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10669 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10670 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10671 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10672 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010673
10674 Example :
10675 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10676 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10677 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10678 listen ssh
10679 bind :22
10680 mode tcp
10681 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010682 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010683 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010684 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010686srv_id : integer
10687 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10688 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10689 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010690
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010691
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106927.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010693----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10696closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10697when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10698usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010699future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010700
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010701ssl_bc : boolean
10702 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10703 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10704 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10705
10706ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10707 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10708 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10709
10710ssl_bc_cipher : string
10711 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10712 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10713
10714ssl_bc_protocol : string
10715 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10716 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10717
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010718ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010719 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010720 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10721 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010722
10723ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10724 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10725 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10726 if session was reused or not.
10727
10728ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10729 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10730 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010732ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10733 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10734 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10735 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10736 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10737 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10740 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10741 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10742 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10743 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745ssl_c_err : integer
10746 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10747 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10748 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10749 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10750 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10753 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10754 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10755 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10756 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10757 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10758 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10759 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10760 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010762ssl_c_key_alg : string
10763 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10764 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10765 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767ssl_c_notafter : string
10768 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10769 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10770 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010772ssl_c_notbefore : string
10773 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10774 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10775 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010777ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10778 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10779 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10780 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10781 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10782 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10783 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10784 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10785 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010787ssl_c_serial : binary
10788 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10789 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10790 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010792ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10793 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10794 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10795 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010796 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10797 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10798
10799 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010801ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10802 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10803 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10804 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010806ssl_c_used : boolean
10807 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10808 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010810ssl_c_verify : integer
10811 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10812 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10813 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10814 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010816ssl_c_version : integer
10817 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10818 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010820ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10821 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10822 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10823 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10824 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010825 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10827 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10828 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_f_key_alg : string
10831 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10832 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10833 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835ssl_f_notafter : string
10836 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10837 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10838 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840ssl_f_notbefore : string
10841 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10842 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10843 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10846 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10847 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10848 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10849 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10850 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10851 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10852 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10853 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855ssl_f_serial : binary
10856 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10857 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10858 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010859
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010860ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10861 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10862 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10863 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010865ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10867 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10868 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010870ssl_f_version : integer
10871 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10872 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10873
10874ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010875 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10876 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10877 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879 Example :
10880 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10881 listen http-https
10882 bind :80
10883 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10884 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10885
10886ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10887 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10888 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10889
10890ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010891 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10893 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10894 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10895 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10896 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10897 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10898 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10899 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010901ssl_fc_cipher : string
10902 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10903 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010905ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010906 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10907 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010908 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10909 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10910 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10911 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10914 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010915 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10916 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10917 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10918 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010920ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010921 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010922 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10923 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10924 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10925 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10926 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10927 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10928 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930ssl_fc_protocol : string
10931 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10932 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010933
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010934ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010935 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010936 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10937 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10940 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10941 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10942 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10943 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945ssl_fc_sni : string
10946 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10947 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10948 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10949 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10950 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10951
10952 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10953 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10954 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010955 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10956 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010958 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010959 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10960 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10963 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10964 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010965
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109677.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10971sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10972only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10973For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10974be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10975can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10976sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10977for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10978content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10981 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10982 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10983 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010985payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10986 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10987 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10988 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990req.len : integer
10991req_len : integer (deprecated)
10992 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10993 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10994 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10995 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10996 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10997 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10998 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10999 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11002 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011003 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11004 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11005 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11006 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011008 ACL alternatives :
11009 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011011req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11012 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11013 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11014 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11015 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 ACL alternatives :
11018 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011020 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022req.proto_http : boolean
11023req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11024 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11025 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11026 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11027 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11028 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11029 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11030 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011032 Example:
11033 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11034 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11035 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011036 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11039rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11040 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11041 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11042 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11043 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11044 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11045 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11046 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11049 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11050 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11051 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11052 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11053 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011055 ACL derivatives :
11056 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 Example :
11059 listen tse-farm
11060 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11061 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11062 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11063 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11064 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11065 persist rdp-cookie
11066 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11067 # This is only useful makes sense if
11068 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11069 stick-table type string size 204800
11070 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11071 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11072 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011074 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11075 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11078rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11079 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11080 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11081 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11082 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 ACL derivatives :
11085 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011087req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11088req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11089 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11090 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11091 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11092 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11093 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11094 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11095 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097req.ssl_sni : string
11098req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11099 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11100 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11101 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11102 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11103 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11104 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11105 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11106 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11107 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11108 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11109 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11110 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112 ACL derivatives :
11113 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115 Examples :
11116 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11117 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11118 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11119 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11120 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11123rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11124 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11125 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11126 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11127 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11128 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11129 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11130 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132req.ssl_ver : integer
11133req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11134 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11135 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11136 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11137 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11138 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11139 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11140 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11141 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11142 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144 ACL derivatives :
11145 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011146
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011147res.len : integer
11148 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11149 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11150 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11151 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11152 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11153 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11154 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11155 content inspection.
11156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11158 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011159 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11160 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11161 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11162 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011164res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11165 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11166 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11167 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11168 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011172wait_end : boolean
11173 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11174 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11175 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11176 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11177 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11178 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11179 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11180 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182 Examples :
11183 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11184 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11185 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11188 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11189 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11190 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11191 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11192 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11193 tcp-request content reject
11194
11195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111967.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197--------------------------------------
11198
11199It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11200This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11201data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11202its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11203HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11204content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11205to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11206more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11207response are indexed.
11208
11209base : string
11210 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11211 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11212 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11213 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11214 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11215 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11216 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11217 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11218
11219 ACL derivatives :
11220 base : exact string match
11221 base_beg : prefix match
11222 base_dir : subdir match
11223 base_dom : domain match
11224 base_end : suffix match
11225 base_len : length match
11226 base_reg : regex match
11227 base_sub : substring match
11228
11229base32 : integer
11230 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11231 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11232 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11233 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11234
11235base32+src : binary
11236 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11237 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11238 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11239 per-URL counters.
11240
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011241capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11242 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11243 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11244 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11245
11246capture.req.method : string
11247 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11248 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11249 because it's allocated.
11250
11251capture.req.uri : string
11252 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11253 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11254 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11255 allocated.
11256
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011257capture.req.ver : string
11258 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11259 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11260 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11261
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011262capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11263 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11264 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11265 The first entry is an index of 0.
11266 See also: "capture response header"
11267
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011268capture.res.ver : string
11269 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11270 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11271 persistent flag.
11272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273req.cook([<name>]) : string
11274cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11275 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11276 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11277 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11278 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11279 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11280 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11281 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11282 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11283
11284 ACL derivatives :
11285 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11286 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11287 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11288 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11289 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11290 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11291 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11292 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11295cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11296 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11297 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11300cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11301 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11302 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11303 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11304 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11308 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11309 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11310 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11311 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11312 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11313 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11314 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11315 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11316 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011318hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11319 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11320 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11321 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11322 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011323 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11326 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11327 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11328 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11329 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11330 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11331 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11332 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11333 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11336 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11337 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11338 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11339 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11342 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11343 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11344 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11345 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11346 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11347 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11348 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11349 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11350 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11351 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11352 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354 ACL derivatives :
11355 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11356 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11357 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11358 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11359 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11360 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11361 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11362 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11363
11364req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11365hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11367 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11368 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11369 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11370 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11371 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11372 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11373 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11374 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11375
11376req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11377hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11378 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11379 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11380 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11381 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11382 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11383 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11384 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11385 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11386
11387req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11388hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11389 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11390 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11391 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11392 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11393 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11394 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11395 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11396
11397http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11398 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11399 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11400 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11401 basic auth is supported.
11402
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011403http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11404 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11405 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11406 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11407 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11409 basic auth is supported.
11410
11411 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011412 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11413 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11414 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11415 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416
11417http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011418 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11419 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11421 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011423method : integer + string
11424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11425 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11426 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11427 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11428 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11429 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11430 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432 ACL derivatives :
11433 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435 Example :
11436 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11437 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11438 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440path : string
11441 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11442 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11443 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11444 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11445 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11446 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11447 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449 ACL derivatives :
11450 path : exact string match
11451 path_beg : prefix match
11452 path_dir : subdir match
11453 path_dom : domain match
11454 path_end : suffix match
11455 path_len : length match
11456 path_reg : regex match
11457 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459req.ver : string
11460req_ver : string (deprecated)
11461 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11462 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11463 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465 ACL derivatives :
11466 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011468res.comp : boolean
11469 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11470 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11471 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011473res.comp_algo : string
11474 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11475 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11476 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011478res.cook([<name>]) : string
11479scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11480 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11481 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11482 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484 ACL derivatives :
11485 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11488scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11489 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11490 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11491 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11494scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11496 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11497 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11500 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11501 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11502 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11503 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11504 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11505 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11506 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11507 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11508 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011510res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11511 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11512 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11513 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11514 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11515 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11518shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11519 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11520 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11521 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11522 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11523 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11524 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11525 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11526 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011528 ACL derivatives :
11529 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11530 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11531 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11532 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11533 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11534 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11535 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11536 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11537
11538res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11539shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11540 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11541 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11542 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11543 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11544 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11547shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11549 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11550 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11551 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11552 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11553 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11556shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11557 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11558 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11559 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11560 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11561 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11562 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564res.ver : string
11565resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11566 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11567 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569 ACL derivatives :
11570 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011572set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11574 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11575 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11576 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011578 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11579 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011583status : integer
11584 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11585 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11586 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011588url : string
11589 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11590 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11591 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11592 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11593 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11594 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11595 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011597 ACL derivatives :
11598 url : exact string match
11599 url_beg : prefix match
11600 url_dir : subdir match
11601 url_dom : domain match
11602 url_end : suffix match
11603 url_len : length match
11604 url_reg : regex match
11605 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011607url_ip : ip
11608 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11609 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11610 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11611 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11612 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11613 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11614 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616url_port : integer
11617 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11618 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11619 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11620 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11623url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11624 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11625 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11626 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11627 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11628 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11629 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11630 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11631 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11632 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634 ACL derivatives :
11635 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11636 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11637 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11638 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11639 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11640 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11641 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11642 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011643
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645 Example :
11646 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11647 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11648 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11649 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11652 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11653 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11654 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011655
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116577.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011658---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011660Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11661every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011662order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11665---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011666FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011667HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011668HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11669HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011670HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11671HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11672HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11673HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11674LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011675METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11676METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11677METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11678METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11679METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11680METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011681RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011683TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011684WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11685---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011686
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116888. Logging
11689----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011690
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011691One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11692provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11693very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11694provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11695state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011696to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697headers.
11698
11699In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11700about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11701send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11702
11703 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11704 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11705 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11706 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11707 at the termination.
11708
11709The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11710allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11711as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11712while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11713real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11714delay.
11715
11716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117178.1. Log levels
11718---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011719
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011720TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011721source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011722HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11723in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11724track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11725syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11726about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727
11728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117298.2. Log formats
11730----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011731
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011732HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011733and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11734slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11735options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011736
11737 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11738 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11739 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11740 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11741 extents.
11742
11743 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11744 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11745 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11746 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11747 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11748
11749 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11750 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11751 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11752 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11753 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11754
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011755 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11756 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11757 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11758 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11759
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011760 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11761
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011762Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11763specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11764field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11765servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11766always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11767identifier.
11768
11769Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11770 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11771 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11772 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11773 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11774
11775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117768.2.1. Default log format
11777-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011778
11779This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11780as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11781format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11782
11783 Example :
11784 listen www
11785 mode http
11786 log global
11787 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11788
11789 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11790 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11791 (www/HTTP)
11792
11793 Field Format Extract from the example above
11794 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11795 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11796 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11797 4 'to' to
11798 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11799 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11800
11801Detailed fields description :
11802 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11803 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11804 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11805 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11806 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11807 and processed the connection.
11808 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11809
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011810In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11811"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11812connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11813
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011814It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11815will eventually disappear.
11816
11817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118188.2.2. TCP log format
11819---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820
11821The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11822is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11823information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11824counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11825emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11826environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11827the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11828sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011829specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11830not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11831fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11832marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011833
11834 Example :
11835 frontend fnt
11836 mode tcp
11837 option tcplog
11838 log global
11839 default_backend bck
11840
11841 backend bck
11842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11843
11844 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11845 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11846 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11847
11848 Field Format Extract from the example above
11849 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11850 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11851 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11852 4 frontend_name fnt
11853 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11854 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11855 7 bytes_read* 212
11856 8 termination_state --
11857 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11858 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11859
11860Detailed fields description :
11861 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011862 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11863 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11864 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11865 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11866 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011867
11868 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011869 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11870 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11871 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011872
11873 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11874 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11875 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11876 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11877
11878 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11879 and processed the connection.
11880
11881 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11882 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11883 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11884 applications.
11885
11886 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11887 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11888 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11889 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11890 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11891
11892 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11893 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11894 See "Timers" below for more details.
11895
11896 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11897 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11898 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11899 "Timers" below for more details.
11900
11901 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011902 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011903 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11904 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11905 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11906 details.
11907
11908 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11909 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11910 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11911 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11912 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11913
11914 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11915 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11916 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11917 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11918 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11919 for more details.
11920
11921 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011922 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011923 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11924 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11925 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011926 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011927
11928 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11929 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11930 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11931 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11932 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11933 caused by a denial of service attack.
11934
11935 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11936 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11937 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11938 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11939 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11940 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11941 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11942 denial of service attack.
11943
11944 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11945 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11946 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11947 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11948 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11949 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11950 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11951 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11952 be processed than on other servers.
11953
11954 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11955 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11956 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11957 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11958 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11959 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11960 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11961 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11962 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11963 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11964 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11965 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11966 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11967
11968 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11969 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11970 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11971 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11972 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11973 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11974 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11975 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11976
11977 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11978 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11979 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11980 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11981 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11982 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11983 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11984 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11985 occurs.
11986
11987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119888.2.3. HTTP log format
11989----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011990
11991The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11992is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11993the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11994are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11995emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11996generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11997"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11998which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011999frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12000is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012001
12002Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12003slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12004with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12005
12006 Example :
12007 frontend http-in
12008 mode http
12009 option httplog
12010 log global
12011 default_backend bck
12012
12013 backend static
12014 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12015
12016 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12017 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12018 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012019 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012020
12021 Field Format Extract from the example above
12022 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12023 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12024 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12025 4 frontend_name http-in
12026 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12027 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12028 7 status_code 200
12029 8 bytes_read* 2750
12030 9 captured_request_cookie -
12031 10 captured_response_cookie -
12032 11 termination_state ----
12033 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12034 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12035 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12036 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12037 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012039
12040Detailed fields description :
12041 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012042 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12043 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12044 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12045 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12046 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012047
12048 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012049 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12050 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12051 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012052
12053 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12054 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12055 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12056 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12057 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12058
12059 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12060 and processed the connection.
12061
12062 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12063 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12064 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12065
12066 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12067 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12068 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12069 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12070 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12071 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12072
12073 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12074 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12075 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12076 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12077 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12078 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12079
12080 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12081 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12082 See "Timers" below for more details.
12083
12084 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12085 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12086 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12087 below for more details.
12088
12089 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12090 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12091 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12092 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12093 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12094 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12095 for more details.
12096
12097 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012098 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012099 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12100 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12101 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12102 details.
12103
12104 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12105 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12106 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12107
12108 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12109 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12110 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12111 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12112 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12113 overflowing.
12114
12115 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12116 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12117 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12118 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12119 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12120 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12121 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12122 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12123
12124 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12125 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12126 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12127 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12128 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12129 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12130 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12131 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12132
12133 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12134 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12135 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12136 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12137 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12138 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12139 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12140
12141 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012142 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012143 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12144 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12145 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147 system.
12148
12149 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12150 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12151 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12152 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12153 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12154 caused by a denial of service attack.
12155
12156 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12157 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12158 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12159 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12160 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12161 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12162 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12163 denial of service attack.
12164
12165 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12166 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12167 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12168 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12169 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12170 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12171 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12172 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12173 processed than on other servers.
12174
12175 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12176 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12177 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12178 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12179 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12180 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12181 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12182 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12183 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12184 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12185 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12186 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12187 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12188
12189 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12190 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12191 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12192 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12193 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12194 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12195 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12196 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12197
12198 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12199 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12200 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12201 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12202 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12203 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12204 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12205 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12206 occurs.
12207
12208 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12209 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12210 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12211 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12212 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12213 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12214 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12215 cookies" below for more details.
12216
12217 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12218 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12219 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12220 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12221 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12222 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12223 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12224 and cookies" below for more details.
12225
12226 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12227 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12228 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12229 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12230 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12231 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12232 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12233 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12234
12235
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122368.2.4. Custom log format
12237------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012238
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012239The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012240mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012241
12242HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12243Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12244separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12245prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12246
12247Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12248variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12249string formats ("Q").
12250
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012251If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012252as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012253less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12254the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12255
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012256Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012257In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012258in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012259
12260Flags are :
12261 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012262 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012263
12264 Example:
12265
12266 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12267 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12268
12269At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12270
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012271 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12272 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012273
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012274the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012275
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012276 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012277 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012278 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012280and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12281
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012282 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012283 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12284
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012285Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12286
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012287 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012288 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012289 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12290 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12291 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012292 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12293 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12294 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012295 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012296 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012297 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012298 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012299 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012300 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012301 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12302 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012303 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012304 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12305 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012306 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012307 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12308 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012309 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12310 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12311 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012312 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012313 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12314 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012315 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012316 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12317 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12318 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012319 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012320 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12321 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12322 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12323 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012324 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012325 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012326 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012327 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012328 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012329 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012330 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12331 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12332 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012333 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012334 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12335 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012336 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012337 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012338 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012340
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012341 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012342
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012343
123448.2.5. Error log format
12345-----------------------
12346
12347When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12348protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12349By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12350"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12351will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12352logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12353
12354The format looks like this :
12355
12356 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12357 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12358 Connection error during SSL handshake
12359
12360 Field Format Extract from the example above
12361 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12362 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12363 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12364 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12365 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12366
12367These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12368failures.
12369
12370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123718.3. Advanced logging options
12372-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012373
12374Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12375just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12376options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12377for more information about their usage.
12378
12379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12381------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012382
12383It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12384haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12385commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12386monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12387ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12388
12389 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12390 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12391 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12392 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12393
12394 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12395 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12396 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012397 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012398 such as other load-balancers.
12399
12400 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12401 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12402 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12403
12404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12406----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012407
12408The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12409what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12410or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12411"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12412just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12413log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12414after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12415is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12416with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12417with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12418
12419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124208.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12421------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012422
12423Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12424for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12425"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12426retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12427raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12428a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12429file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12430you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12431"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12432
12433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124348.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12435--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012436
12437Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12438multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12439them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12440"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12441logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12442error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12443and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12444too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12445useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12446alternative.
12447
12448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124498.4. Timing events
12450------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012451
12452Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12453reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12454the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12455frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12456mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12457
12458 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12459 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12460 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12461 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12462 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12463
12464 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12465 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12466 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12467 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12468 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12469
12470 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12471 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12472 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12473 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12474 connection never established.
12475
12476 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12477 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12478 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12479 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12480 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12481 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12482 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12483 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12484 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12485 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12486 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12487
12488 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12489 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12490 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12491 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012492 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012493
12494 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12495
12496 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12497 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12498 negative.
12499
12500These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12501protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12502that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012503due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012504close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12505session has been aborted on timeout.
12506
12507Most common cases :
12508
12509 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12510 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12511 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12512 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12513 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12514 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12515 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12516 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12517 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012518 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12519 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12520 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012521
12522 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12523 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12524 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12525 of ms on remote networks.
12526
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012527 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12528 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12529 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012530
12531 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12532 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12533 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12534 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12535 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12536 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12537 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12538 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12539 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12540 to the server until another one is released.
12541
12542Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12543
12544 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12545 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12546 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12547
12548 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12549 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12550 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12551
12552 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12553 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12554 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12555 flags.
12556
12557 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12558 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12559 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12560 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12561 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12562 the client connection was maintained open.
12563
12564 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012565 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012566 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12567 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12568
12569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125708.5. Session state at disconnection
12571-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012572
12573TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12574"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12576each of which has a special meaning :
12577
12578 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12579 session to terminate :
12580
12581 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12582
12583 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12584 server explicitly refused it.
12585
12586 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12587 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12588 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12589 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012590 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12591
12592 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12593 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012594
12595 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12596 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12597 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12598 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12599 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12600
12601 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12602 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12603 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12604 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12605 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12606
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012607 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12608 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12609
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012610 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12611 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12612 backup connections when going up.
12613
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012614 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12615
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012616 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12617 send or receive data.
12618
12619 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12620 send or receive data.
12621
12622 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12623 with nothing left in the buffers.
12624
12625 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12626
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012627 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012628 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12629
12630 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12631 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12632 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12633 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12634 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12635
12636 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12637 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12638
12639 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12640 server (HTTP only).
12641
12642 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12643
12644 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12645 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12646 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12647
12648 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12649 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12650 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12651
12652 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12653
12654 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12655 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12656
12657 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12658 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12659 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12660
12661 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12662 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012663 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12664 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012665
12666 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12667 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12668 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12669 another server.
12670
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012671 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012672 server.
12673
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012674 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12675 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12676 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12677 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12678
12679 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12680 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12681 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12682 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12683
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012684 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12685 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12686 "use-server" rule).
12687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12689
12690 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12691 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12692
12693 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12694
12695 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12696 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12697 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12698
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012699 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12700 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012701 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012702 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12703 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012705 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12706
12707 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12708 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12709
12710 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12711
12712 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12713
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012714The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12715was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012716helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12717starvation, attacks, etc...
12718
12719The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12720alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12721easier finding and understanding.
12722
12723 Flags Reason
12724
12725 -- Normal termination.
12726
12727 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12728 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12729 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12730 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12731
12732 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12733 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12734 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12735 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12736 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12737 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012739 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12740 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012741 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012742
12743 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12744 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12745 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12746
12747 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12748 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12749 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12750 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12751 the server takes too long to respond.
12752
12753 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12754 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12755 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12756 long a time to respond.
12757
12758 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12759 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12760 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12761 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12762 and the client.
12763
12764 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12765 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12766 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12767 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12768 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012769 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12770 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12771 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12772 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12773 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12774 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12775 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12776 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12777 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12778 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12779 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12780 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12781 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12782 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012783
12784 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12785 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012786 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12787 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12788 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12789 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012790
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012791 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12792 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012794 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012795 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12796 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12797 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12798 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12799 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12800
12801 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12802 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12803 503 or 504 here.
12804
12805 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12806 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12807 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12808 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12809 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12810
12811 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12812 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012813 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012814 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12815 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12816
12817 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12818 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12819 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12820 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12821 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12822 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12823 between haproxy and the server.
12824
12825 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12826 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12827 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12828 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12829 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12830 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12831 solution is to fix the application.
12832
12833 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12834 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12835 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12836 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12837 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12838 external attacks.
12839
12840 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12841 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012842 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012843 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12844 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12845
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012846 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12847 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12848 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012849 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12850 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012851
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012852 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12853 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12854 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12855 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012856 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12857 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12858 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12859 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12860 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012861
12862 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12863 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12864 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12865 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12866
12867 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12868 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12869 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12870 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12871
12872 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12873 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12874 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12875 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12876
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012877The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12878persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12879important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12880re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12881
12882 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12883
12884 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12885 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12886 set on a GET request.
12887
12888 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12889 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012890 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012891 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12892
12893 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12894 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12895 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12896
12897 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12898 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12899 already got a cookie.
12900
12901 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12902 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12903 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12904 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12905 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12906
12907 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12908 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12909 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12910
12911 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12912 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12913 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12914
12915 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12916 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12917
12918 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12919 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12920 then advertised in the response.
12921
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129238.6. Non-printable characters
12924-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012925
12926In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12927consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12928converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12929prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12930being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12931escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12932is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12933'}' when logging headers.
12934
12935Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12936issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12937containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12938
12939Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12940the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12941performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12942
12943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129448.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12945---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012946
12947Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12948achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012949section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012950cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12951the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12952the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012954not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12955user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12956a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12957wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12958
12959 Examples :
12960 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12961 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12962
12963 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12964 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12965
12966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129678.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12968---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012969
12970Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12971proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12972the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12973server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12974
12975Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12976response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012977section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012978
12979It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012980time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12981appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012982are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12983and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12984follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12985request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12986in the logs.
12987
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012988As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12989frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12990an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012992 Example :
12993 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12994 listen proxy-out
12995 mode http
12996 option httplog
12997 option logasap
12998 log global
12999 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13000
13001 # log the name of the virtual server
13002 capture request header Host len 20
13003
13004 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13005 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13006
13007 # log the beginning of the referrer
13008 capture request header Referer len 20
13009
13010 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13011 capture response header Server len 20
13012
13013 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13014 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13015
13016 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13017 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13018
13019 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13020 capture response header Via len 20
13021
13022 # log the URL location during a redirection
13023 capture response header Location len 20
13024
13025 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13026 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13027 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13028 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13029 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13030
13031 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13032 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13033 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13034 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013035 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013036
13037 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13038 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13039 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13040 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13041 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013042 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013043
13044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130458.9. Examples of logs
13046---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013047
13048These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13049them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13050reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13051
13052 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13053 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13054 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13055
13056 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13057 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13058
13059 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13060 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13061 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13062
13063 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13064 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13065
13066 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13067 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13068 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13069
13070 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013071 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013072 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13073 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13074
13075 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13076 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13077 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13078
13079 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13080 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013081 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013082 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13083 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13084 to return the 502 and not the server.
13085
13086 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013087 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013088
13089 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13090 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13091 Nothing was sent to any server.
13092
13093 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13094 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13095
13096 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13097 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13098 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13099 send a 408 return code to the client.
13100
13101 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13102 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13103
13104 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13105 5 seconds ("c----").
13106
13107 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13108 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013109 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013110
13111 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013112 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013113 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13114 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13115 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13116 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13117 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013118
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131209. Statistics and monitoring
13121----------------------------
13122
13123It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13124mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13125CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13126Unix socket.
13127
13128
131299.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013130---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013131
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013132The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013133page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13134begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13135represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13136use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13137('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13138(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13139text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13140do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13141use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013143 0. pxname: proxy name
13144 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
13145 for server)
13146 2. qcur: current queued requests
13147 3. qmax: max queued requests
13148 4. scur: current sessions
13149 5. smax: max sessions
13150 6. slim: sessions limit
13151 7. stot: total sessions
13152 8. bin: bytes in
13153 9. bout: bytes out
13154 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013155 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013156 12. ereq: request errors
13157 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013158 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013159 15. wretr: retries (warning)
13160 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010013161 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013162 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13163 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13164 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13165 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
13166 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
13167 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
13168 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
13169 25. qlimit: queue limit
13170 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13171 27. iid: unique proxy id
13172 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
13173 29. throttle: warm up status
13174 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
13175 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020013176 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020013177 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13178 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
13179 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013180 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013181 UNK -> unknown
13182 INI -> initializing
13183 SOCKERR -> socket error
13184 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13185 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13186 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13187 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13188 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13189 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13190 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13191 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13192 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13193 disable-on-404
13194 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13195 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13196 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013197 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
13198 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013199 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
13200 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
13201 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
13202 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
13203 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
13204 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013205 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
13206 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13207 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13208 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013209 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13210 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010013211 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13212 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13213 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013214 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013215 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreaua28df3e2014-06-16 16:40:14 +020013216 56. last_chk: last health check contents or textual error
13217 57. last_agt: last agent check contents or textual error
Willy Tarreauf5b1cc32014-06-17 12:20:59 +020013218 58. qtime: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13219 59. ctime: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13220 60. rtime: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests (0 for TCP)
13221 61. ttime: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013222
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132249.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013225-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013226
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013227The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13228necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13229A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13230issuing commands by hand :
13231
13232 global
13233 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13234 stats timeout 2m
13235
13236It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13237the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13238never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13239situations :
13240
13241 global
13242 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13243 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13244 stats timeout 2m
13245
13246To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13247swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13248to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13249syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13250
13251 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13252 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13253
13254The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13255script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13256for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13257
13258The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13259that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13260editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13261(eg: watch a counter).
13262
13263The socket supports two operation modes :
13264 - interactive
13265 - non-interactive
13266
13267The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13268this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13269sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13270mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13271commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13272example :
13273
13274 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13275
13276The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13277entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13278for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13279sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13280"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13281after processing the last command of the same line.
13282
13283For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13284"prompt" command :
13285
13286 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13287 prompt
13288 > show info
13289 ...
13290 >
13291
13292Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13293delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13294that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13295parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013296
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013297It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13298on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13299own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013300
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013301The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13302If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13303all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13304it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13305
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013306add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013307 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13308 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13309 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13310 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013311
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013312add map <map> <key> <value>
13313 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13314 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013315 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13316 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13317 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013319clear counters
13320 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13321 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13322 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13323 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13324 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13325
13326clear counters all
13327 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13328 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13329 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13330
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013331clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013332 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13333 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13334 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013335
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013336clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013337 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13338 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13339 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013340
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013341clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13342 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13343
13344 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13345 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13346 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13347 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13348 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13349 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13350
13351 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13352
13353 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13354 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13355 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13356 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13357 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13358 the ACLs :
13359
13360 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13361 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13362 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13363 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13364 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13365 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13366
13367 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013368 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13369 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013370
13371 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013372 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013373 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013374 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13375 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13376 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13377 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013378
13379 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13380
13381 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013382 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013383 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13384 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013385 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13386 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13387 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013388
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013389del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13390 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013391 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13392 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13393 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13394 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013395
13396del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013397 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013398 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13399 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13400 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13401 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013402
13403disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013404 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13405
13406 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13407 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13408 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13409 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13410 re-enabled using enable agent.
13411
13412 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13413 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13414 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13415 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13416 otherwise unchanged.
13417
13418 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13419 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13420 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13421
13422 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13423 level "admin".
13424
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013425disable frontend <frontend>
13426 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13427 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13428 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13429 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13430 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13431 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13432 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13433 on the stats page.
13434
13435 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13436 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13437
13438 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13439 level "admin".
13440
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013441disable health <backend>/<server>
13442 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13443 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13444 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13445 agent check forces it down.
13446
13447 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13448 level "admin".
13449
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013450disable server <backend>/<server>
13451 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13452 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13453 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13454 during the maintenance.
13455
13456 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13457 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13458
13459 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013460 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013461
13462 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13463 level "admin".
13464
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013465enable agent <backend>/<server>
13466 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13467
13468 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13469 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13470
13471 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13472 level "admin".
13473
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013474enable frontend <frontend>
13475 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13476 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13477 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13478 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13479 which was disabled.
13480
13481 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13482 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13483
13484 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13485 level "admin".
13486
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013487enable health <backend>/<server>
13488 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13489 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13490
13491 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13492 level "admin".
13493
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013494enable server <backend>/<server>
13495 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13496 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13497
13498 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013499 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013500
13501 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13502 level "admin".
13503
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013504get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013505get acl <acl> <value>
13506 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13507 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13508 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13509 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13510 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013511
13512 The first two words are:
13513
13514 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13515 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13516 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13517
13518 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13519
13520 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13521
13522 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13523
13524 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13525 interpretation of the case.
13526
13527 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13528 useful with regular expressions.
13529
13530 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13531 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13532
13533 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13534 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13535 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13536
13537 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13538
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013539get weight <backend>/<server>
13540 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13541 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13542 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13543 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13544 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013545 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013546
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013547help
13548 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13549 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013550
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013551prompt
13552 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13553 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13554 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13555 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13556 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13557 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13558 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13559 command.
13560
13561quit
13562 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013563
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013564set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013565 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13566 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13567 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013568
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013569set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013570 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13571 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13572 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13573 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13574 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013575 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13576 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13577
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013578set maxconn global <maxconn>
13579 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13580 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13581 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13582 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13583 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13584 setting.
13585
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013586set rate-limit connections global <value>
13587 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13588 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13589 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13590 is passed in number of connections per second.
13591
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013592set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13593 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13594 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013595 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13596 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013597
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013598set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13599 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13600 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13601 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13602 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13603
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013604set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13605 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13606 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13607 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13608 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13609 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13610
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013611set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13612 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13613 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13614 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13615
13616set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13617 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13618 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13619 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13620
13621set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13622 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13623 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13624 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13625 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13626 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13627 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13628 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13629 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13630
13631set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13632 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13633 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13634
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013635set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13636 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13637 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13638 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13639 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13640
13641 Example:
13642 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13643 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13644 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13645 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13646
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013647set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013648 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13649 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13650 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13651 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013652 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13653 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013654
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013655set timeout cli <delay>
13656 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13657 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13658 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13659
13660set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13661 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13662 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013663 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13664 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13665 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13666 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13667 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13668 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13669 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13670 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13671 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13672 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13673 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13674 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13675 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013676
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013677show errors [<iid>]
13678 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13679 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013680 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13681 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13682 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013683
13684 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13685 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13686 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13687 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13688 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13689 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13690 are reported too.
13691
13692 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13693 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13694 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13695 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13696 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13697 code.
13698
13699 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13700 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13701 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13702 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13703 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13704 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13705 line.
13706
13707 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013708 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13709 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013710 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13711 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13712
13713 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13714 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13715 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13716 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13717 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13718 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13719 00204+ minal\r\n
13720 00211 \r\n
13721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013722 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013723 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13724 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13725 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13726 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13727 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13728 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013729
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013730show info
13731 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13732
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013733show map [<map>]
13734 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013735 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13736 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13737 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13738 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13739 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13740 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013741
13742show acl [<acl>]
13743 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013744 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13745 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13746 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13747 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13748 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013749
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013750show pools
13751 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13752 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13753 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13754 the pools.
13755
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013756show sess
13757 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013758 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13759 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13760
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013761show sess <id>
13762 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13763 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13764 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13765 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13766 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013767 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13768 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13769 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013770
13771show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13772 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13773 possible to dump only selected items :
13774 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13775 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13776 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13777 for example:
13778 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13779 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13780 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13781
13782 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013783 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13784 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013785 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13786 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13787 Nbproc: 1
13788 Process_num: 1
13789 (...)
13790
13791 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13792 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13793 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13794 (...)
13795 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13796
13797 $
13798
13799 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13800 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13801 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13802 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013803 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013804
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013805show table
13806 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13807 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13808 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13809 entries currently in use.
13810
13811 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013812 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013813 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13814 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013815
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013816show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013817 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13818 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13819 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013820 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13821
13822 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13823 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13824 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13825 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13826 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13827
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013828 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13829 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13830 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13831 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13832 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13833 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13834
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013835
13836 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013837 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13838 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013839
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013840 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013841 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013842 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013843 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13844 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13845 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13846 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013847
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013848 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013849 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013850 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13851 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013852
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013853 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13854 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013855 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013856 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13857 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013858
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013859 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13860 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013861 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013862 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13863 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13864
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013865 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13866 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13867 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13868 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13869 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13870
13871 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13872 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13873 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013874 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13875 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013876 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13877 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013878
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013879shutdown frontend <frontend>
13880 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13881 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13882 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13883 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13884 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13885 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13886 once it is terminated.
13887
13888 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13889 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13890
13891 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13892 level "admin".
13893
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013894shutdown session <id>
13895 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13896 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13897 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13898 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13899 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13900 flag in the logs.
13901
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013902shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13903 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13904 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13905 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13906 'K' flag in the logs.
13907
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013908/*
13909 * Local variables:
13910 * fill-column: 79
13911 * End:
13912 */